blob: 118bd9716a75e77e417641babbd1defa122e7708 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau396d2002020-04-02 09:02:11 +02007 2020/04/02
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
481file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200482
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200483* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
484 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
485
486* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
487 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
488 directory.
489
490* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 processes, separated by semicolons.
494
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500495* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496 CLI, separated by semicolons.
497
498See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200499
5002.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200501----------------
502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100503Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100504values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
505otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
506numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
507for every keyword. Supported units are :
508
509 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
510 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
511 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
512 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
513 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
514 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
515
516
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005172.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200518-------------
519
520 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
521 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
522 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
523 global
524 daemon
525 maxconn 256
526
527 defaults
528 mode http
529 timeout connect 5000ms
530 timeout client 50000ms
531 timeout server 50000ms
532
533 frontend http-in
534 bind *:80
535 default_backend servers
536
537 backend servers
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
542 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
543 global
544 daemon
545 maxconn 256
546
547 defaults
548 mode http
549 timeout connect 5000ms
550 timeout client 50000ms
551 timeout server 50000ms
552
553 listen http-in
554 bind *:80
555 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
556
557
558Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
559
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100560 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200561
562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005633. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564--------------------
565
566Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
567are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
568of them have command-line equivalents.
569
570The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
571
572 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200573 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200575 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - description
579 - deviceatlas-json-file
580 - deviceatlas-log-level
581 - deviceatlas-separator
582 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900583 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - gid
585 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100586 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200587 - h1-case-adjust
588 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200589 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100591 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200593 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200594 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200595 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200596 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200597 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100598 - presetenv
599 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200600 - uid
601 - ulimit-n
602 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200603 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100604 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200605 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200607 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - ssl-default-bind-options
609 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200610 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - ssl-default-server-options
612 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100613 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100614 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100615 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100616 - 51degrees-data-file
617 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200618 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200619 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200620 - wurfl-data-file
621 - wurfl-information-list
622 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200623 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100624
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200626 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200628 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100629 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100630 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100631 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200632 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200633 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200634 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200635 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 - noepoll
637 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000638 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100640 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300641 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000642 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100643 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200644 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200645 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200646 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000647 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000648 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200649 - tune.buffers.limit
650 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200651 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200652 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100653 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200654 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200655 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200656 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100657 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200658 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200659 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100660 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100661 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100662 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100663 - tune.lua.session-timeout
664 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200665 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100666 - tune.maxaccept
667 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200668 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200669 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200670 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100671 - tune.rcvbuf.client
672 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100673 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200674 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100675 - tune.sndbuf.client
676 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100677 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100678 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200679 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100680 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200681 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200682 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100683 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200684 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100685 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200686 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
687 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
688 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100689 - tune.zlib.memlevel
690 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100691
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200692 * Debugging
693 - debug
694 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695
696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006973.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698------------------------------------
699
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200700ca-base <dir>
701 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200702 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
703 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705chroot <jail dir>
706 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
707 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
708 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
709 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
710 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100712
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100713cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
714 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
715 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
716 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
717 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
718 set. These sets have the format
719
720 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
721
722 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100723 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100724 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
725 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100726 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
727 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100728 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100729 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100731 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100732 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
733 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
734 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
735 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100736
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100737 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
738 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
739 on the machine's word size.
740
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100742 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
743 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
744 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
745 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
746 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
747 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100748
749 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100750 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
751
752 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
753 # first 4 CPUs
754
755 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
756 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
757 # word size.
758
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100761 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
762 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
763 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
764
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100765 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
766 # and so on.
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
768 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
769 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
770
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100771 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100772 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
773 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
774 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
775
776 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
777 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
778 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
779
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100780 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
781 # and a thread range.
782 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
783 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
784 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
785
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200786crt-base <dir>
787 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
788 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
789 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
790
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200791daemon
792 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
793 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100794 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
795 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200797deviceatlas-json-file <path>
798 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200800
801deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100802 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200803 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
804
805deviceatlas-separator <char>
806 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
807 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
808
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100809deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200810 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
811 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
812 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100813
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900814external-check
815 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
816 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
817 See "option external-check".
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819gid <number>
820 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
821 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
822 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100823 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
824 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200825 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Willy Tarreau8b852462019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100827group <group name>
828 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
829 See also "gid" and "user".
830
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100831hard-stop-after <time>
832 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
833
834 Arguments :
835 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
836 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
837 SIGUSR1 signal.
838
839 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
840 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
841 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
842
843 Example:
844 global
845 hard-stop-after 30s
846
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200847h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
848 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
849 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
850 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
851 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500852 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200853 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
854 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
855 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
856 specified in a proxy.
857
858 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
859 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
860 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
861 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
862 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
863 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
864 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
865
866 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
867 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
868 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
869 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
870 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
871
872 Example:
873 global
874 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
875
876 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
877 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
878
879h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
880 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
881 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
882 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
883 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
884 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
885 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
886 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
887 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
888
889 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
890 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
891 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
892
893 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
894 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
895
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200896log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
897 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100898 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100899 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100900 configured with "log global".
901
902 <address> can be one of:
903
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100904 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100905 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
906 port).
907
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100908 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
909 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
910 port).
911
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100912 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100913 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
914 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100915 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100916
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100917 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
918 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
919 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
920 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
921 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
922 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
923 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
924 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
925 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
926 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
927 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
928 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
929 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
930 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100931 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
932 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100933
934 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
935 "fd@2", see above.
936
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200937 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
938 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100939
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200940 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
941 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
942 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
943 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
944 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
945 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
946 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
947 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
948 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
949 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100950 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
951 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200952
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200953 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
954 one of the following :
955
956 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
957 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
958
959 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
960 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
961
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100962 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
963 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
964 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
965 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
966 logger consumes.
967
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100968 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
969 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
970 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
971 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
972
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200973 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
974 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
975 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
976 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
977 set with <sample_size> parameter.
978
979 <sample_size>
980 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
981 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
982 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
983 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
984 (see also <ranges> parameter).
985
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100986 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200987
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100988 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
989 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
990 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
991
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100992 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
993 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
994 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
995 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200996
997 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200998 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
999 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1000 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1001 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1002 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1003 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001004
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001005 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001007log-send-hostname [<string>]
1008 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1009 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1010 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1011 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1012 the logs.
1013
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001014log-tag <string>
1015 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1016 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1017 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001018 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001019
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001020lua-load <file>
1021 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1022 used multiple times.
1023
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001024master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001025 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1026 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1027 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001028 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001029 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1030 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001031 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1032 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1033 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1034 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1035 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001036
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001037 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001038
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001039mworker-max-reloads <number>
1040 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001041 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001042 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1043 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1044 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1045
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001046nbproc <number>
1047 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1048 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1049 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001050 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1051 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001052 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1053 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001055nbthread <number>
1056 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001057 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1058 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1059 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1060 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1061 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001062 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1063 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1064 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1065 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1066 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1067 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1068 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001069
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001071 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001072 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1073 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1074
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001075presetenv <name> <value>
1076 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1077 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1078 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1079 and "unsetenv".
1080
1081resetenv [<name> ...]
1082 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1083 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1084 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1085 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1086 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1087 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1088 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1089 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1090
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001091stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001092 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1093 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1094 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1095 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1096 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1097 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001098 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001099 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1100 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1101 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1102 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001103
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001104server-state-base <directory>
1105 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001106 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1107 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001108
1109server-state-file <file>
1110 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1111 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1112 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1113 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1114 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1115 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1116 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1117 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001118 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1119 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001120
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001121setenv <name> <value>
1122 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1123 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1124 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1125 and "unsetenv".
1126
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001127set-dumpable
1128 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1129 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1130 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1131 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1132 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1133 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1134 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1135 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1136 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1137 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1138 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1139 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1140 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1141 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1142 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1143 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1144 expected when dying.
1145
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001146ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1148 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001149 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001150 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001151 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1152 information and recommendations see e.g.
1153 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1154 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1155 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1156 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001157
1158ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1160 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1161 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1162 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1163 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001164 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1165 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1166 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001167 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001168
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001169ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1170 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1171 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1172 keyword to see available options.
1173
1174 Example:
1175 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001176 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001177
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001178ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1179 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1180 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001181 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001182 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001183 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1184 information and recommendations see e.g.
1185 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1186 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1187 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1188 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1189 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001190
1191ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1193 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1194 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1195 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1196 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001197 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1198 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1199 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1200 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001201
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001202ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1204 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1205 keyword to see available options.
1206
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001207ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1209 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1210 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001211 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001212 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001213 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1214 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1215 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1216 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001217 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1218 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1219 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1220
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001221ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1222 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1223 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1224 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1225
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001226stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1227 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1228 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1229 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001230 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001231 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001232
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001233 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1234 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1235 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001236
1237stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1238 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1239 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001240 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001241
1242stats maxconn <connections>
1243 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1244 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1245
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001246uid <number>
1247 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1248 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1249 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1250 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1251
1252ulimit-n <number>
1253 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1254 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1255 option.
1256
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001257unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1258 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1259
1260 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1261 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1262 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1263 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1264 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1265 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1266 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1267 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1268 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1269 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1270
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001271unsetenv [<name> ...]
1272 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1273 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1274 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1275 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1276 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1277 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1278 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1279
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001280user <user name>
1281 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1282 See also "uid" and "group".
1283
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001284node <name>
1285 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1286
1287 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1288 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1289 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1290 traffic.
1291
1292description <text>
1293 Add a text that describes the instance.
1294
1295 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1296 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1297 "<" and ">" characters.
1298
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100129951degrees-data-file <file path>
1300 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001301 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001302
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001303 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001304 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1305
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000130651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001307 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1308 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1309 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1310
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001311 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001312 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1313
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200131451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001315 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1316 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1317
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001318 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1319 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1320
132151degrees-cache-size <number>
1322 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1323 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1324 By default, this cache is disabled.
1325
1326 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001327 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1328
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001329wurfl-data-file <file path>
1330 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1331 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1332
1333 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1334 with USE_WURFL=1.
1335
1336wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1337 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1338 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1339 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1340
1341 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1342
1343 Valid WURFL properties are:
1344 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1345
1346 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1347 device.
1348
1349 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1350 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1351
1352 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1353 particular web request.
1354
1355 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1356 used Libwurfl API version.
1357
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001358 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1359 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1360
1361 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1362 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1363
1364 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1365
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001366 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1367 with USE_WURFL=1.
1368
1369wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1370 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1371 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1372
1373 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1374 with USE_WURFL=1.
1375
1376wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1377 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1378 thus before the chroot.
1379
1380 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1381 with USE_WURFL=1.
1382
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001383wurfl-cache-size <size>
1384 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1385 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001386 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001387 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001388
1389 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1390 with USE_WURFL=1.
1391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001393-----------------------
1394
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001395busy-polling
1396 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1397 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1398 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1399 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1400 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1401 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1402 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1403 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1404 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1405 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1406 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1407 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1408 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1409 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1410 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1411 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1412 "poll" pollers.
1413
William Dauchy857b9432019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001414 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1415 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1416 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1417
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001418max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1419 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1420 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1421 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1422 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1423 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1424 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1425 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1426 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1427
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001428maxconn <number>
1429 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1430 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1431 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001432 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1433 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1434 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1435 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001436 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1437 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1438 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1439 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1440 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1441 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001442
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001443maxconnrate <number>
1444 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1445 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1446 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1447 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1448 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1449 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1450 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1451 fairness.
1452
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001453maxcomprate <number>
1454 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001455 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001456 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1457 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1458 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001459 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001460 default value.
1461
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001462maxcompcpuusage <number>
1463 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1464 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1465 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1466 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1467 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1468 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1469 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1470 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1471
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001472maxpipes <number>
1473 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1474 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1475 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1476 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1477 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1478 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1479
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001480maxsessrate <number>
1481 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1482 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1483 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1484 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1485 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1486 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1487 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1488 fairness.
1489
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001490maxsslconn <number>
1491 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1492 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1493 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1494 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1495 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1496 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1497 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001498 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1499 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1500 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1501 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1502 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1503 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1504 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001505
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001506maxsslrate <number>
1507 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1508 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1509 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1510 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1511 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1512 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1513 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1514 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1515 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1516 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1517
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001518maxzlibmem <number>
1519 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1520 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1521 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001522 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1523 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1524 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1525
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001526noepoll
1527 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1528 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001529 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001530
1531nokqueue
1532 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1533 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1534 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1535
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001536noevports
1537 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1538 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1539 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1540 also "nopoll".
1541
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001542nopoll
1543 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1544 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001545 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001546 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1547 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001549nosplice
1550 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001551 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001552 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001553 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001554 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1555 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1556 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1557 "option splice-response".
1558
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001559nogetaddrinfo
1560 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1561 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1562
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001563noreuseport
1564 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1565 command line argument "-dR".
1566
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001567profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1568 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1569 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1570 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1571 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001572 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001573 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1574 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1575 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1576 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1577
1578 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1579 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1580 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1581 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1582 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001583 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1584 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1585 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1586 CLI.
1587
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001588spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001589 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1590 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1591 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1592 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1593 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1594 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001595
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001596ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001597 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001598 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001599 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1600 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1601 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1602 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1603 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1605 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001606 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1607 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1608 openssl configuration file uses:
1609 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1610
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001611ssl-mode-async
1612 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001613 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001614 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1615 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1616 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001617 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001618 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001619
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001620tune.buffers.limit <number>
1621 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1622 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1623 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1624 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1625 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001626 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001627 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1628 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1629 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1630 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1631 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1632 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1633 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1634 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1635 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1636
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001637tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1638 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1639 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1640 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1641 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1642
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001643tune.bufsize <number>
1644 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1645 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1646 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1647 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1648 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1649 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1650 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001651 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1652 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1653 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001654 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001655 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1656 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1657 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001658
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001659tune.chksize <number>
1660 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1661 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1662 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1663 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1664 checks whenever possible.
1665
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001666tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1667 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1668 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1669 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1670 this value. The default value is 1.
1671
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001672tune.fail-alloc
1673 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1674 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1675 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1676 gracefully.
1677
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001678tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1679 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1680 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1681 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1682 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1683 change it.
1684
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001685tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1686 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1688 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001689 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1690 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1691 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1692 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1693 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1694
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001695tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1696 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1697 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1698 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1699 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1700 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1701 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1702 recommended not to change this value.
1703
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001704tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1705 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1706 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1707 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1708 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1709 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1710 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1711 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1712
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001713tune.http.cookielen <number>
1714 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1715 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1716 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1717 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1718 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1719 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1720 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1721 to change this value.
1722
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001723tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001724 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1725 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001726 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001727 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001728 configuration directives too.
1729 The default value is 1024.
1730
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001731tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1732 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1733 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1734 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1735 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1736 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1737 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001738 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1739 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1740 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001741
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001742tune.idletimer <timeout>
1743 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1744 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1745 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1746 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1747 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1748 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001749 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001750 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001751 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1752
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001753tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1754 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1755 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1756 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1757 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1758 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1759 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1760 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1761 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1762 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1763
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001764tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1765 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001766 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001767 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1768 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001769 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001770 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1771 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1772
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001773tune.lua.maxmem
1774 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1775 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1776 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1777 memory.
1778
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001779tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1780 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001781 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1782 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001783 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001784
1785tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1786 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1787 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1788 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1789 check servers.
1790
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001791tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1792 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1793 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1794 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001795 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001796
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001797tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001798 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1799 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1800 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1801 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1802 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1803 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1804 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1805 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1806 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1807 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001808
1809tune.maxpollevents <number>
1810 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1811 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1812 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1813 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1814 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1815
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001816tune.maxrewrite <number>
1817 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1818 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1819 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1820 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1821 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1822 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1823 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1824 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1825 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1826 bufsize.
1827
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001828tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1829 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1830 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1831 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1832 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1833 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1834 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1835 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1836 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1837 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau7fdd81c2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02001838 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
1839 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001840 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1841 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1842 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1843 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1844 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1845 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1846 setting this parameter to 0.
1847
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001848tune.pipesize <number>
1849 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1850 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1851 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1852 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1853 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1854 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1855
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001856tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1857 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1858 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1859 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1860 default is 20.
1861
1862tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1863 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1864 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1865 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1866 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1867 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1868 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001869 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001870
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001871tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1872tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1873 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1874 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1875 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001876 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001877 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001878 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1879 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1880
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001881tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001882 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001883 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1884 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1885 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1886 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1887
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001888tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001889 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001890 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1891 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1892
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001893tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1894tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1895 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1896 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1897 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001898 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001899 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001900 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1901 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1902 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1903 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1904 notifying haproxy again.
1905
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001906tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001907 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1908 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1909 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001910 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001911 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001912 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001913 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1914 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1915 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001916 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1917 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001918
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001919tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001920 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001921 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1922 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1923 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1924 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1925 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1926
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001927tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1928 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001929 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001930 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1931 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1932 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1933 being used for too long.
1934
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001935tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1936 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1937 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1938 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1939 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1940 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1941 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1942 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1943 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1944 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1945 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001946 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001947 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001948
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001949tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1950 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1951 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1952 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1953 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1954 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1955 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1956 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001957 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1958 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001959
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001960tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1961 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1962 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1963 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1964 1000 entries.
1965
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001966tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1967 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1968 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1969 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1970
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001971tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001972tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001973tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1974tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1975tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001976 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1977 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1978 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1979 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1980 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1981 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1982 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1983 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001984
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001985 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1986 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1987 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1988 all available space is consumed.
1989 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1990 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1991 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001992
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001993tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1994 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001995 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001996 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001997 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001998 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1999
2000tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2001 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2002 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002003 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2004 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020063.3. Debugging
2007--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002008
2009debug
2010 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2011 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2012 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2013 system startup.
2014
2015quiet
2016 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2017 line argument "-q".
2018
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020203.4. Userlists
2021--------------
2022It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2023http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2024it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2025
2026userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002027 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002028 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2029
2030group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002031 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002032 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2033 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2034
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002035user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2036 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002037 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2038 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002039 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2040 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2041 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2042 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002043
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002044 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2045 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2046 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2047 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2048 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2049 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2050 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2051 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2052 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002053
2054 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002055 userlist L1
2056 group G1 users tiger,scott
2057 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002058
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002059 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2060 user scott insecure-password elgato
2061 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002062
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002063 userlist L2
2064 group G1
2065 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002066
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002067 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2068 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2069 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002070
2071 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002072
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002073
20743.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002075----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002076It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2077several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2078instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2079values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2080automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2081In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2082using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2083tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2084reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2085Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2086that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2087each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002088
2089peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002090 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002091 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2092
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002093bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2094 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2095 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2096
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002097disabled
2098 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2099 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2100 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2101
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002102default-bind [param*]
2103 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2104
2105default-server [param*]
2106 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2107
2108 Arguments:
2109 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2110 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2111 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2112 details.
2113
2114
2115 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2116
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002117enable
2118 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2119
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002120peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002121 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2122 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2123 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2124 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2125 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2126 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2127
2128 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2129 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2130
2131 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2132 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2133 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2134 across all peers.
2135
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002136 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2137 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002138
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002139 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2140 "server" keyword explanation below).
2141
2142server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002143 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002144 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2145 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2146 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2147 of this "peers" section).
2148 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2149
2150
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002151 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002152 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002153 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002154 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2155 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2156 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002157
2158 backend mybackend
2159 mode tcp
2160 balance roundrobin
2161 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2162 stick on src
2163
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002164 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2165 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002166
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002167 Example:
2168 peers mypeers
2169 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2170 default-server ssl verify none
2171 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2172 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002173
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002174
2175table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2176 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2177
2178 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2179 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002180 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002181 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2182 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2183 "stick-table" keyword).
2184
2185 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2186 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2187 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2188 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2189 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2190 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2191 of the stick-table name as follows:
2192
2193 peers mypeers
2194 peer A ...
2195 peer B ...
2196 table t1 ...
2197
2198 frontend fe1
2199 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2200
2201 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2202 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2203
2204 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2205 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2206 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2207 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2208 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2209 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2210 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2211
2212 peers mypeers
2213 peer A ...
2214 peer B ...
2215 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2216
2217 backend t1
2218 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2219
2220 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2221 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2222 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2223
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090022243.6. Mailers
2225------------
2226It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2227If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2228in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2229
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002230mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002231 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2232 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2233
2234mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2235 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2236
2237 Example:
2238 mailers mymailers
2239 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2240 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2241
2242 backend mybackend
2243 mode tcp
2244 balance roundrobin
2245
2246 email-alert mailers mymailers
2247 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2248 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2249
2250 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2251 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2252
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002253timeout mail <time>
2254 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2255 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2256 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2257 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2258
2259 Example:
2260 mailers mymailers
2261 timeout mail 20s
2262 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002263
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022643.7. Programs
2265-------------
2266In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2267master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2268managed the same way as the workers.
2269
2270During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2271sequence as a worker:
2272
2273 - the master is re-executed
2274 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2275 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2276 instance of the program
2277
2278During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2279
2280program <name>
2281 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2282 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2283 the management guide).
2284
2285command <command> [arguments*]
2286 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2287 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2288 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2289 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2290
2291option start-on-reload
2292no option start-on-reload
2293 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2294 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2295 program section.
2296
2297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002299----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002300
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002302 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002303 - frontend <name>
2304 - backend <name>
2305 - listen <name>
2306
2307A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2308its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2309section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002310section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002311
2312A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2313connections.
2314
2315A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2316to forward incoming connections.
2317
2318A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2319parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002321All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2322'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2323case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2324
2325Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2326logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2327proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2328However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2329name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2330
2331Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2332and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002333bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002334protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2335modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2336arbitrary criteria.
2337
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002338In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2339a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto599788e2019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002340the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002341
2342 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2343 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2344 between responses and new requests.
2345
2346 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2347 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2348 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002349 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2350 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2351 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2352 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002353
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002354 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2355 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2356 client-facing connection remains open.
2357
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002358 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2359 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002360
2361The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2362frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2363following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002364weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002365
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002366 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002367
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002368 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2369 ----+-----+-----+----
2370 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2371 ----+-----+-----+----
2372 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2373 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2374 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2375 ----+-----+-----+----
2376 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002377
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002379
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023804.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2381--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002383The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2384limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2385they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2386limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002387marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002388option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002389and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2390with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2391specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002392
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002393
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002394 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2395------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2396acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002397backlog X X X -
2398balance X - X X
2399bind - X X -
2400bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002401block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002402capture cookie - X X -
2403capture request header - X X -
2404capture response header - X X -
2405clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002406compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002407contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2408cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002409declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002410default-server X - X X
2411default_backend X X X -
2412description - X X X
2413disabled X X X X
2414dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002415email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002416email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002417email-alert mailers X X X X
2418email-alert myhostname X X X X
2419email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002420enabled X X X X
2421errorfile X X X X
2422errorloc X X X X
2423errorloc302 X X X X
2424-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2425errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002426force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002427filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002428fullconn X - X X
2429grace X X X X
2430hash-type X - X X
2431http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002432http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002433http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002434http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002435http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002436http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002437http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002438id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002439ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002440load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002441log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002442log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002443log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002444log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002445max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002446maxconn X X X -
2447mode X X X X
2448monitor fail - X X -
2449monitor-net X X X -
2450monitor-uri X X X -
2451option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2452option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2453option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2454option allbackups (*) X - X X
2455option checkcache (*) X - X X
2456option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2457option contstats (*) X X X -
2458option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2459option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002460-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2461option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002462option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2463option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002464option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002465option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002466option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002467option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002468option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002469option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002470option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002471option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002472option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002473option httpchk X - X X
2474option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002475option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002476option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002477option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002478option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002479option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002480option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2481option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2482option logasap (*) X X X -
2483option mysql-check X - X X
2484option nolinger (*) X X X X
2485option originalto X X X X
2486option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002487option pgsql-check X - X X
2488option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002489option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002490option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002491option smtpchk X - X X
2492option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2493option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2494option splice-request (*) X X X X
2495option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002496option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002497option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2498option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2499-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002500option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002501option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2502option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2503option tcpka X X X X
2504option tcplog X X X X
2505option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002506external-check command X - X X
2507external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002508persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2509rate-limit sessions X X X -
2510redirect - X X X
2511redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2512redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002513reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2514reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2515reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2516reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2517reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2518reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2519reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2520reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2521reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2522reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2523reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2524reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002525-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002526reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002527retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002528retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002529rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2530rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2531rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2532rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2533rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2534rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2535rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002536server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002537server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002538server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002539source X - X X
2540srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002541stats admin - X X X
2542stats auth X X X X
2543stats enable X X X X
2544stats hide-version X X X X
2545stats http-request - X X X
2546stats realm X X X X
2547stats refresh X X X X
2548stats scope X X X X
2549stats show-desc X X X X
2550stats show-legends X X X X
2551stats show-node X X X X
2552stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002553-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2554stick match - - X X
2555stick on - - X X
2556stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002557stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002558stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002559tcp-check connect - - X X
2560tcp-check expect - - X X
2561tcp-check send - - X X
2562tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002563tcp-request connection - X X -
2564tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002565tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002566tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002567tcp-response content - - X X
2568tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002569timeout check X - X X
2570timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002571timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002572timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2573timeout connect X - X X
2574timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2575timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2576timeout http-request X X X X
2577timeout queue X - X X
2578timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002579timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002580timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2581timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002582timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002583transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002584unique-id-format X X X -
2585unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002586use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002587use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002588------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2589 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2593---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002594
2595This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2596
2597
2598acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2599 Declare or complete an access list.
2600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2601 no | yes | yes | yes
2602 Example:
2603 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2604 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2605 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2606
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002607 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
2609
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002610backlog <conns>
2611 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2613 yes | yes | yes | no
2614 Arguments :
2615 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2616 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002617 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002618
2619 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2620 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2621 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2622 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2623 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2624 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2625 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2626 backlog parameter.
2627
2628 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2629 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2630 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2631
2632 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2633
2634
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002635balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002636balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2639 yes | no | yes | yes
2640 Arguments :
2641 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2642 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2643 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2644 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2645
2646 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2647 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2648 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2649 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002650 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002651 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002652 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2653 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2654 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2655 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2656 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2657 it, so that you don't worry.
2658
2659 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2660 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2661 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2662 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2663 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2664 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2665 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2666 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002668 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2669 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2670 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2671 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2672 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2673 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2674 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2675 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2676
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002677 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002678 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002679 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2680 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002681 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002682 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2683 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2684 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2685 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2686 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002687 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2688 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2689 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2690 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2691 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2692 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002693
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002694 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2695 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2696 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2697 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2698 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2699 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2700 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2701 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002702 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002704 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2705 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2706 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002707
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002708 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2709 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2710 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2711 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2712 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2713 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2714 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2715 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2716 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2717 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2718 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2719 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002721 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002722 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2723 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2724 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2725 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2726 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2727 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2728 URIs start with a leading "/".
2729
2730 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2731 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2732 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2733 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2734
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002735 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002736 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2737
2738 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002739 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2740 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002741 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2742 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2743 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2744 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002745 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002746 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2747 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002748
2749 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2750 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2751 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2752 server will receive the request.
2753
2754 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2755 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2756 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2757 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2758 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002759 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2760 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2761 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002762
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002763 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2764 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2765 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2766 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2767 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002769 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002770 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2771 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2772 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2773
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002774 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2775 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2776 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2777
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002778 random
2779 random(<draws>)
2780 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002781 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2782 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2783 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2784 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002785 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2786 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2787 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2788 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2789 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2790 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2791 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2792 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2793 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2794 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2795 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2796 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2797 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2798 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2799 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2800 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2801 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2802 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2803 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2804 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002805
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002806 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002807 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002808 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2809 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2810 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2811 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2812 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2813 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002814 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002815 used instead.
2816
2817 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2818 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2819 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2820 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2821
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002822 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2823 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2824 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2825
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002826 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002829 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2830 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002831
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002832 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2833 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2834 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002836 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002837 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002838 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2839 NTLM relies on.
2840
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002841 Examples :
2842 balance roundrobin
2843 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002844 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002845 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2846 balance hdr(host)
2847 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002848
2849 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2850 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002852 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002853 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2854 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2855 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2856 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2857
2858 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2859 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2860 defaults to 16 kB.
2861
2862 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2863 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2864
2865 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2866 Round Robin.
2867
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002868 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002869 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2870 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2871 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2872
2873 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2874
2875 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002876 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002877 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2878 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2879 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002880
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002881 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002882
2883
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002884bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2885bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002886 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2888 no | yes | yes | no
2889 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002890 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2891 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2892 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2893 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002894 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002895 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2896 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2897 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2898 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2899 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2900 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2901 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002902 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2903 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2904 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2905 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2906 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2907 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2908 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002909 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2910 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2911 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002912 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2913 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2914 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2915 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002916 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2917 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2918 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002919
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002920 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2921 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002922 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2923 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2924 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002925 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2926 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2927 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2928 the range.
2929
2930 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2931 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2932 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2933 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2934 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2935 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2936 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002937 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002938 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002940 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002941 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002942 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2943 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2944 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2945 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2946 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2947 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2948
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002949 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2950 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2951 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2952 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2955 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2956 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2957 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2958 in a frontend.
2959
2960 Example :
2961 listen http_proxy
2962 bind :80,:443
2963 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002964 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002965
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002966 listen http_https_proxy
2967 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002968 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002969
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002970 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2971 bind ipv6@:80
2972 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2973 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2974
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002975 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002976 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002977
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002978 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2979 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2980 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2981 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2982 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2983
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002984 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002985 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002986
2987
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002988bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002989 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2991 yes | yes | yes | yes
2992 Arguments :
2993 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2994 may be used to override a default value.
2995
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002996 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002997 option may be combined with other numbers.
2998
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002999 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003000 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3001 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3002 missing from all processes.
3003
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003004 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003005 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003006 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3007 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3008 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3009 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3010 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003011 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003012
3013 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3014 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3015 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3016 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3017 and 'even' instances.
3018
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003019 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3020 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3021 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3022 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003023
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003024 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3025 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3026
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003027 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3028 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3029 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3030
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003031 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3032 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3033
3034 Example :
3035 listen app_ip1
3036 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003037 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003038
3039 listen app_ip2
3040 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003041 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003042
3043 listen management
3044 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003045 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003046
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003047 listen management
3048 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3049 bind-process 1-4
3050
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003051 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003052
3053
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003054block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003055 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
3056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3057 no | yes | yes | yes
3058
3059 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3060 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003061 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003062 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003063 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003064 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3065 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3066 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003067
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003068 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3069 "http-request deny" instead.
3070
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071 Example:
3072 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3073 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3074 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003075 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3076 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3077 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003079 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3080 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3081 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082
3083capture cookie <name> len <length>
3084 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3086 no | yes | yes | no
3087 Arguments :
3088 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3089 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3090 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3091 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003092 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003093
3094 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3095 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3096 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3097 right if it exceeds <length>.
3098
3099 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3100 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3101 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3102 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3103
3104 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3105 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3106 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3107
3108 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3109 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3110 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003111 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3112 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3113 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003114
3115 Example:
3116 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3117
3118 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003119 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
3121
3122capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003123 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3125 no | yes | yes | no
3126 Arguments :
3127 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003128 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3130 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3131 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3132
3133 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3134 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3135 it exceeds <length>.
3136
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003137 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3139 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003140 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3141 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3142 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3143 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003144 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003145 environments to find where the request came from.
3146
3147 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3148 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3149 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3150 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003152 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3153 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3154 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3155 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3156 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003157
3158 Example:
3159 capture request header Host len 15
3160 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003161 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003163 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003164 about logging.
3165
3166
3167capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003168 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 no | yes | yes | no
3171 Arguments :
3172 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003173 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003174 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3175 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3176 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3177
3178 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3179 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3180 it exceeds <length>.
3181
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003182 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3184 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3185 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003186 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3187 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3188 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3189 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003190
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003191 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3192 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3193 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3194 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3195 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196
3197 Example:
3198 capture response header Content-length len 9
3199 capture response header Location len 15
3200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003201 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003202 about logging.
3203
3204
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003205clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 yes | yes | yes | no
3209 Arguments :
3210 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3211 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3212 as explained at the top of this document.
3213
3214 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3215 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3216 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3217 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3218 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3219 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3220 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3221 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003222 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003223 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003224 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003225
3226 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3227 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3228 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3229 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3230 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3231 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3232
3233 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3234 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3235
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003236 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3237 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003238
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003239compression algo <algorithm> ...
3240compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003241compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003242 Enable HTTP compression.
3243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3244 yes | yes | yes | yes
3245 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003246 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3247 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3248 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3249
3250 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003251 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3252 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3253 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003254
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003255 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003256 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003257
3258 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3259 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3260 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3261 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3262 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003263 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003264
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003265 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3266 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3267 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3268 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3269 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3270 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3271 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003272 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003273
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003274 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003275 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003276 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3277 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3278 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3279 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3280 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003281
3282 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3283 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3284 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3285 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3286 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003287 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3288 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3289 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3290 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3291 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003292 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3293 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003294
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003295 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003296 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3297 "Accept-Encoding" header
3298 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003299 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003300 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3301 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3302 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3303 "multipart"
3304 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3305 header
3306 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3307 and later
3308 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3309 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003310 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003311
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003312 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003313
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003314 Examples :
3315 compression algo gzip
3316 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003317
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003318
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003319contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3322 yes | no | yes | yes
3323 Arguments :
3324 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3325 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3326 as explained at the top of this document.
3327
3328 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003329 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003330 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003332 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3333 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3334 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3335
3336 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3337 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3338 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3339 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3340 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3341 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3342
3343 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3344 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3345 instead.
3346
3347 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3348 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3349
3350
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003351cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003352 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3353 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003354 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003355 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 yes | no | yes | yes
3358 Arguments :
3359 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3360 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3361 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3362 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3363 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3364 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003365 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3367 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3368
3369 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3370 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3371 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3372 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3373 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3374 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003375 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3376 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003377 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003378 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3379 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003380
3381 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003382 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003383
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003384 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003385 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003386 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003387 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003388 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3389 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3390 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3391 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3392 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3393 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3394 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003395
3396 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3397 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3398 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3399 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3400 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3401 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3402 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3403 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3404 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003405 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003406 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3407 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3408 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003410 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3411 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3412 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003413 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3414 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3415 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3416 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003417 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3418 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3419 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003420
3421 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3422 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3423 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3424 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3425 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3426 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3427 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3428 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3429 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3430
3431 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3432 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3433 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3434 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3435 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3436 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3437 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3438 persistence cookie in the cache.
3439 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3440
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003441 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3442 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3443 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3444 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3445 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003446 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003447 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3448 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3449 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3450 they logout.
3451
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003452 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3453 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3454 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3455 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3456
3457 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3458 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3459 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3460 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3461 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3462 this attribute.
3463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003464 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003465 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003466 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3467 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3468 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3469 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3470 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3471 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003472
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003473 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3474 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3475 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3476 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3477 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3478 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3479 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3480 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003481 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003482 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3483 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3484 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3485 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3486 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3487 the site.
3488
3489 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3490 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3491 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3492 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3493 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3494 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3495 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3496 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3497 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3498 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3499 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3500 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3501 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003502 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003503 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3504 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3505
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003506 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3507 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3508 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3509 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3510 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3511 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3512
Christopher Fauletdb2cdbb2020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003513 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3514 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3515 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3516 repeated.
3517
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003518 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3519 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3520 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3521 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003522
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003523 Examples :
3524 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3525 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3526 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003527 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003529 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003530
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003531
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003532declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3533 Declares a capture slot.
3534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3535 no | yes | yes | no
3536 Arguments:
3537 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3538
3539 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3540 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3541 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3542 for use in the response.
3543
3544 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003545 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003546 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3547
3548
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003549default-server [param*]
3550 Change default options for a server in a backend
3551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3552 yes | no | yes | yes
3553 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003554 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3555 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3556 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3557 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003558
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003559 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003560 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3561
3562 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003563
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003565default_backend <backend>
3566 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3568 yes | yes | yes | no
3569 Arguments :
3570 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3571
3572 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3573 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3574 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3575 will catch all undetermined requests.
3576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003577 Example :
3578
3579 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3580 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3581 default_backend dynamic
3582
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003583 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003584
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003585
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003586description <string>
3587 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3589 no | yes | yes | yes
3590 Arguments : string
3591
3592 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3593 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3594 it describes.
3595 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3596
3597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003598disabled
3599 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | yes | yes | yes
3602 Arguments : none
3603
3604 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3605 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3606 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3607 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3608 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3609 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3610 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3611
3612 See also : "enabled"
3613
3614
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003615dispatch <address>:<port>
3616 Set a default server address
3617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3618 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003619 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003620
3621 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3622 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3623 during start-up.
3624
3625 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3626 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3627 possible with normal servers.
3628
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003629 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003630 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3631 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3632 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3633 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3634
3635 See also : "server"
3636
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003637
3638dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3639 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3641 yes | no | yes | yes
3642 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3643
3644 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003645 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003646 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3647 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003648 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003649 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003650
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003651enabled
3652 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 yes | yes | yes | yes
3655 Arguments : none
3656
3657 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3658 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3659
3660 See also : "disabled"
3661
3662
3663errorfile <code> <file>
3664 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3666 yes | yes | yes | yes
3667 Arguments :
3668 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003669 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3670 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003671
3672 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003673 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003675 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3676 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003677
3678 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3679 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3680 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3681
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003682 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3683
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3685 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3686 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3687 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3688
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003689 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3690 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003691 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003692 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3693 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3694 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003696 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3697 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3698 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003699 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003700 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3701
3702 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3703
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003704 Example :
3705 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003706 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003707 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3708 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3709
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003710
3711errorloc <code> <url>
3712errorloc302 <code> <url>
3713 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3715 yes | yes | yes | yes
3716 Arguments :
3717 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003718 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3719 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003720
3721 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3722 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3723 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3724 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003725 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003726
3727 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3728 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3729 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3730
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003731 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3732
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003733 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3734 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3735 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3736 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003737 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003738 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3739 request.
3740
3741 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3742
3743
3744errorloc303 <code> <url>
3745 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3747 yes | yes | yes | yes
3748 Arguments :
3749 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003750 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3751 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003752
3753 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3754 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3755 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3756 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003757 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003758
3759 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3760 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3761 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3762
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003763 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3764
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003765 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3766 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3767 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3768 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003769 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003770
3771 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3772
3773
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003774email-alert from <emailaddr>
3775 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003776 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3778 yes | yes | yes | yes
3779
3780 Arguments :
3781
3782 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3783
3784 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3785 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3786
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003787 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003788 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3789 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003790
3791
3792email-alert level <level>
3793 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3794 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3796 yes | yes | yes | yes
3797
3798 Arguments :
3799
3800 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3801 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3802 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3803
3804 By default level is alert
3805
3806 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3807 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3808 for the proxy.
3809
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003810 Alerts are sent when :
3811
3812 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3813 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3814 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3815 is notice or lower
3816 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3817 and a health check status update occurs
3818
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003819 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3820 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003821 section 3.6 about mailers.
3822
3823
3824email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3825 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3827 yes | yes | yes | yes
3828
3829 Arguments :
3830
3831 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3832
3833 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3834 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3835
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003836 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3837 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003838
3839
3840email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3841 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3842 mailers.
3843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 yes | yes | yes | yes
3845
3846 Arguments :
3847
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003848 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003849
3850 By default the systems hostname is used.
3851
3852 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3853 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3854 for the proxy.
3855
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003856 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3857 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003858
3859
3860email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003861 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003862 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3864 yes | yes | yes | yes
3865
3866 Arguments :
3867
3868 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3869
3870 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3871 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3872
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003873 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003874 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3875
3876
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003877force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3878 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003880 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003881
3882 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3883 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3884 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3885 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3886 marked down for maintenance operations.
3887
3888 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3889 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3890 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3891 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3892 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3893 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3894 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3895 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3896 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3897
3898 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3899 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3900 is used.
3901
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003902 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003903 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003904
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003905
3906filter <name> [param*]
3907 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3909 no | yes | yes | yes
3910 Arguments :
3911 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3912 referenced in section 9.
3913
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003914 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003915 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003916 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3917 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003918
3919 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3920 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3921
3922 Example:
3923 listen
3924 bind *:80
3925
3926 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3927 filter compression
3928 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3929
3930 compression algo gzip
3931 compression offload
3932
3933 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3934
3935 See also : section 9.
3936
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003938fullconn <conns>
3939 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3941 yes | no | yes | yes
3942 Arguments :
3943 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3944 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3945
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003946 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003947 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003948 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003949 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3950 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3951 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3952 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3953 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003954 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003955
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003956 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3957 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003958 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3959 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3960 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003961
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003962 Example :
3963 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3964 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3965 # connections.
3966 backend dynamic
3967 fullconn 10000
3968 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3969 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3970
3971 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3972
3973
3974grace <time>
3975 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003977 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003978 Arguments :
3979 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3980 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3981 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3982
3983 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3984 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003985 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003986 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3987
3988 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3989 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3990 simplify it.
3991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003992
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003993hash-balance-factor <factor>
3994 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3996 yes | no | no | yes
3997 Arguments :
3998 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3999 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004000 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004001
4002 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4003 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4004 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4005 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4006 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4007 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4008 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4009
4010 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4011 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4012 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4013 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4014 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4015
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004016 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4017 consistent hashing mechanism.
4018
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004019 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4020
4021
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004022hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004023 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4025 yes | no | yes | yes
4026 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004027 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4028 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004029
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004030 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4031 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4032 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4033 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4034 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4035 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4036 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4037 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4038 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4039 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004040
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004041 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4042 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4043 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4044 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4045 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4046 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4047 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4048 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4049 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4050 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4051 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4052 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4053 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004054 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4055 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004056
4057 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4058
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004059 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004060 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4061 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4062 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004063 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4064 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4065 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004066
4067 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4068 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004069 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4070 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4071 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4072 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4073
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004074 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4075 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4076 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4077 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4078 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4079 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4080 parameter.
4081
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004082 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4083 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4084 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4085 used on strings.
4086
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004087 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4088
4089 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4090 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4091 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4092 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4093 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4094 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4095 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4096 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4097 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4098 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4099 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4100 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004101
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004102 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4103 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4104 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004105
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004106 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004107
4108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004109http-check disable-on-404
4110 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004112 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004113 Arguments : none
4114
4115 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4116 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4117 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4118 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4119 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4120 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4121 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4122 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004123 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4124 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4125 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4126
4127 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4128
4129
4130http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004131 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004133 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004134 Arguments :
4135 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4136 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004137 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004138 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4139 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4140 details on the supported keywords.
4141
4142 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4143 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4144 with the usual backslash ('\').
4145
4146 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4147 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4148 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4149 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4150 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4151
4152 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004153 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004154 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4155 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4156 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4157
4158 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004159 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004160 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4161 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4162 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4163 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4164
4165 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004166 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004167 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4168 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4169 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4170 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4171 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004172 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004173 trace).
4174
4175 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004176 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004177 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4178 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4179 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4180 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4181 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004182 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004183
4184 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4185 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4186 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4187 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4188 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4189 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4190 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4191 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4192
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004193 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4194 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4195 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4196
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004197 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4198 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4199
4200 Examples :
4201 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004202 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004203
4204 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004205 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004206
4207 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004208 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004209
4210 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004211 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004213 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004214
4215
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004216http-check send-state
4217 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4219 yes | no | yes | yes
4220 Arguments : none
4221
4222 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4223 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4224 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4225 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4226 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4227
4228 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4229 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4230 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4231 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4232 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004233 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4234 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4235 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4236
4237 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4238 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4239 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4240
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004241 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4242 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4243 checked in multiple backends.
4244
4245 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4246 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4247
4248 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4249 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4250 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4251 one fails.
4252
4253 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4254 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4255 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4256
4257 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4258 server's queue.
4259
4260 Example of a header received by the application server :
4261 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4262 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4263
4264 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004266
4267http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004268 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4269
4270 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4271 no | yes | yes | yes
4272
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004273 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4274 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4275 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4276 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4277 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004279 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4280 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004281
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004282 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4285 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4286 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4287 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4290 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4291 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4292 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004294 Example:
4295 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4296 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4297 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299 http-request allow if nagios
4300 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4301 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4302 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004304 Example:
4305 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4306 acl add path /addacl
4307 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004308
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004309 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4312 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004313
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004314 Example:
4315 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4316 acl setmap path /setmap
4317 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004318
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004319 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4322 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4325 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004326
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004327http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004328
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004329 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4330 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4331 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4332 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4333 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4334 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4335 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4336 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004339
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004340 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4341 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4342 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4343 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4344 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4345 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4346 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4347 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004348
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004349http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004350
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004351 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4352 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004353
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004355http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4358 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4359 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4360 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4361 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004363 Example:
4364 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4365 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004366
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004367http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004371http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4372 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004374 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4375 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4376 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4377 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4378 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4379 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4380 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4381 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4382 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4385 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4386 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01004387 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
4388
4389 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
4390 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
4391 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
4392 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004394http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004395
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004396 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4397 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4398 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4399 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4400 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4401 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004402
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004403http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004405 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004407http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004409 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4410 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4411 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4412 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4413 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4414 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004415
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004416http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004418 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4419 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4420 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4421 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4422 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004423
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004424http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4425 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4426 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4427 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4428
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004429http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4430
4431 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4432 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4433 pointed by <resolvers>.
4434 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4435 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4436 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4437 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4438 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4439 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4440 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4441 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4442 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4443 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4444 to 0.0.0.0.
4445
4446 Example:
4447 resolvers mydns
4448 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4449 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4450 timeout retry 1s
4451 hold valid 10s
4452 hold nx 3s
4453 hold other 3s
4454 hold obsolete 0s
4455 accepted_payload_size 8192
4456
4457 frontend fe
4458 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4459 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4460 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4461
4462 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4463 # which mean DNS resolution error
4464 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4465
4466 default_backend be
4467
4468 backend b_503
4469 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4470 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4471 # 503 error page to end users
4472
4473 backend be
4474 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4475 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4476 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4477 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4478 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4479
4480 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4481 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4482
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004483http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4484
4485 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4486 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4487 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4488 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004489 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4490 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004491
4492 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004494http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4497 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4498 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4499 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4500 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004502http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004504 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4505 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4506 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4507 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004508
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004509http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4510 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004511
Ilya Shipitsin5c836fd2020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004512 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004513 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
4514 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
4515 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
4516 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
4517 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004518
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004519 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
4520 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
4521 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
4522 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
4523 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004524
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004525 Example:
4526 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
4527
4528 # applied to:
4529 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4530
4531 # outputs:
4532 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
4533
4534 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004535
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004536 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
4537
4538 # applied to:
4539 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004540
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004541 # outputs:
4542 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004543
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004544http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4545 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4546
4547 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
4548 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
4549 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
4550 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
4551
4552 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4553 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4554 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
4555
4556 Example:
4557 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4558 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
4559
4560 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4561 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4562
4563 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4564 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
4565 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4566 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4567
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004568http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4569 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4570
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004571 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
4572 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
4573 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
4574 against.
4575
4576 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
4577 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
4578 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004579
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004580 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
4581 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
4582 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
4583 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
4584 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
4585 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
4586 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
4587 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
4588 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreaudfc85772019-12-17 06:52:51 +01004589 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
4590 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004591
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004592 Example:
4593 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
4594 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004595
Willy Tarreaud41821d2019-12-17 06:51:20 +01004596 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4597 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004599http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4600 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004601
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004602 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4603 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4604 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4605 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004606
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004607 Example:
4608 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004609
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004610 # applied to:
4611 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004612
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01004613 # outputs:
4614 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004616http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4617http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004619 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4620 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4621 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004623http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004624
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004625 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4626 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4627 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004630
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004631 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4632 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4633 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4634 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4635 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004636
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004637 Arguments:
4638 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4639 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641 Example:
4642 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4643 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004645 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4646 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004648http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004650 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4651 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4652 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004654 Arguments:
4655 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4656 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004657
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004658 Example:
4659 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4660 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004662 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4663 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4664 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004666http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004667
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004668 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4669 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4670 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4671 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4672 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004674 Example:
4675 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4676 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4677 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4678 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4679 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4680 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4681 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4682 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4683 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004684
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004685http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004686
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004687 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4688 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4689 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4690 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4691 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004693http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4694 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004695
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004696 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4697 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4698 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4699 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4700 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4701 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4702 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4703 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4704 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004706http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004708 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4709 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4710 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4711 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4712 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4713 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4714 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004715
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004716http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004718 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4719 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4720 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004722http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004724 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4725 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4726 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4727 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4728 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4729 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4730 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4731 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004733http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004734
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004735 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4736 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4737 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4738 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4739 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4740 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004742 Example :
4743 # prepend the host name before the path
4744 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004745
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004746http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004748 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4749 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4750 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4751 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4752 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004753
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004754http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004755
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004756 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4757 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4758 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4759 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4760 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4761 values have higher priority.
4762 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4763 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4764 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4765 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4766 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004767
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004768http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004769
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004770 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4771 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4772 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4773 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4774 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4775 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4776 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004778 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004779
4780 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004781 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4782 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004783
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004784http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4785 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4786 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4787 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004788 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
4789 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004790
4791 Arguments :
4792 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4793 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004794
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004795 See also "option forwardfor".
4796
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004797 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004798 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4799 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4800
Olivier Doucet46c517f2020-04-21 09:32:56 +02004801 # After the masking this will track connections
4802 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
4803 http-request track-sc0 src
4804
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004805 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4806 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4807
4808http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4809
4810 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4811 expression.
4812
4813 Arguments:
4814 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4815 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004816
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004817 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004818 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4819 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4820
4821 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4822 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4823 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4824
4825http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4826
4827 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4828 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4829 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4830 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4831 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4832 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4833 information from the request.
4834
4835 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4836
4837http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4838
4839 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4840 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4841 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4842 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4843 path and the query string.
4844 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4845
4846http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4847
4848 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4849 inline.
4850
4851 Arguments:
4852 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4853 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4854 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4855 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4856 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4857 (request and response)
4858 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4859 processing
4860 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4861 processing
4862 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4863 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4864 and '_'.
4865
4866 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4867 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004868
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004869 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004870 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004871
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004872http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4873 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004874
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004875 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4876 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4877 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4878 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4879 agent name must be used.
4880
4881 Arguments:
4882 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4883
4884 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4885 configuration.
4886
4887http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4888
4889 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4890 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4891 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4892 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4893 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4894 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4895 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4896 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4897 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4898 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4899 action.
4900 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4901 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4902 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4903 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4904 you fully understand how it works.
4905
4906http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4907
4908 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4909 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4910 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4911 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4912 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4913 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4914 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4915 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4916 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4917 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4918 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4919 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4920 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4921
4922http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4923http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4924http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4925
4926 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4927 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4928 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4929 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4930 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4931 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4932 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4933 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4934 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4935 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4936 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4937 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4938
4939 Arguments :
4940 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4941 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4942 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4943 select which table entry to update the counters.
4944
4945 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4946 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4947 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4948 that table until the session ends.
4949
4950 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4951 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4952 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4953 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4954 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4955 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4956 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4957 useful information.
4958
4959 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4960 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4961 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4962 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4963 checks that make use of it.
4964
4965http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4966
4967 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004968
4969 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004970 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004971
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01004972http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4973
4974 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
4975 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
4976 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
4977 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
4978 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
4979 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
4980
4981 Arguments :
4982 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
4983
4984 Example:
4985 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
4986
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004987http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004989 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4990 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4991 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004992
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004993
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004994http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004995 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4996
4997 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4998 no | yes | yes | yes
4999
5000 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5001 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5002 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5003 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5004 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5005 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005007 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5008 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005010 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005011
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005012 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
5013 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
5014 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
5015 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005017 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
5018 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
5019 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
5020 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005022 Example:
5023 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005024
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005025 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005027 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5028 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005030 Example:
5031 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005033 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005035 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5036 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005038 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5039 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005041http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005043 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5044 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5045 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5046 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5047 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5048 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5049 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5050 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005052http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005053
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005054 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5055 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5056 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5057 example, or to pass some internal information.
5058 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5059 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5060 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005062http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005064 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5065 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005066
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005067http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005069 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005071http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005073 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5074 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5075 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5076 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5077 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5078 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5079 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005081 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5082 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5083 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5084 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5085 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann63b220d2020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005086
5087 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5088 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5089 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5090 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005091
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005092http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005094 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5095 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5096 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5097 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5098 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5099 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005100
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005101http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005103 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005105http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005107 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5108 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5109 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5110 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5111 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5112 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005113
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005114http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005116 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
5117 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005119http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005121 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
5122 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
5123 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
5124 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
5125 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
5126 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005128http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5129 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02005130
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005131 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
5132 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005134 Example:
5135 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005137 # applied to:
5138 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005139
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005140 # outputs:
5141 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005143 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005144
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005145http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5146 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005147
Tim Duesterhus2f7045c2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005148 This works like "http-response replace-value" except that it works on the
5149 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005150
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005151 Example:
5152 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005153
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005154 # applied to:
5155 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005156
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005157 # outputs:
5158 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005160http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5161http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005163 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5164 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5165 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005167http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005169 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5170 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5171 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005173http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005175 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5176 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5177 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5178 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5179 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005181 Arguments:
5182 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005184 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5185 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005187http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005188
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005189 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5190 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5191 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005193http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5194
5195 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5196 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5197 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5198 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5199 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5200
5201http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5202
5203 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5204 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5205 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5206 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5207 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5208 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5209 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5210 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5211 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5212
5213http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5214
5215 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5216 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5217 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5218 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5219 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5220 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5221 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5222
5223http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5224
5225 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5226 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5227 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5228 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5229 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5230 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5231 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5232 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5233
5234http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5235 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5236
5237 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5238 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5239 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5240 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005241
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005242 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005243 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5244 http-response set-status 431
5245 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5246 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005248http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005249
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005250 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5251 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5252 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5253 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5254 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5255 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5256 based on some information from the request.
5257
5258 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5259
5260http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5261
5262 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5263 inline.
5264
5265 Arguments:
5266 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5267 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5268 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5269 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5270 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5271 (request and response)
5272 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5273 processing
5274 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5275 processing
5276 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5277 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5278 and '_'.
5279
5280 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5281 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005282
5283 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005284 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005285
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005286http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005287
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005288 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5289 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5290 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5291 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5292 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5293 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5294 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5295 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5296 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5297 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5298 action.
5299 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5300 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5301 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5302 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5303 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005304
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005305http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5306http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5307http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005308
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005309 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5310 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5311 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5312 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5313 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5314 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5315
5316http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5317
5318 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5319 about <var-name>.
5320
5321 Example:
5322 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5323
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005324
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005325http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5326 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5327
5328 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 yes | no | yes | yes
5330
5331 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005332 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5333 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5334 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005335
5336 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5337
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005338 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5339 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5340 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5341 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5342 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5343 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5344 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5345 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5346 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5347 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005348
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005349 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5350 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5351 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5352 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5353 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5354 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5355 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5356 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005357
5358 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5359 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5360 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5361 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5362 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5363 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5364 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5365 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005366 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005367 downsides of rare connection failures.
5368
5369 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5370 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5371 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5372 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5373 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5374 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005375 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005376 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5377 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5378 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5379 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5380 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5381
5382 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005383 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5384 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5385 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005386
5387 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005388 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005389
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005390 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5391 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005392
Lukas Tribus79a56932019-11-06 11:50:25 +01005393 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005394
5395 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5396 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5397 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5398
5399 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5400
5401
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005402http-send-name-header [<header>]
5403 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005404 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5405 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005406 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005407 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5408
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005409 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5410 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5411 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5412 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5413 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5414 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5415 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5416 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5417 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5418 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5419 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5420 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5421 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5422 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5423 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5424 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005425
5426 See also : "server"
5427
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005428id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005429 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5431 no | yes | yes | yes
5432 Arguments : none
5433
5434 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5435 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5436 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005437
5438
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005439ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5440 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5441 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005442 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005443
5444 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5445 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5446 and running).
5447
5448 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5449 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5450 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005451 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005452 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5453
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005454 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5455 "unless" condition is met.
5456
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005457 Example:
5458 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5459 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5460 ignore-persist if url_static
5461
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005462 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5463
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005464load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5465 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5466 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5467 yes | no | yes | yes
5468
5469 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5470 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5471 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005472 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005473 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5474 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5475 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5476 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5477
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005478 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005479 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005480 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005481
5482 Arguments:
5483 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5484 named "server-state-file".
5485
5486 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5487 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5488 name is used as a file name.
5489
5490 none don't load any stat for this backend
5491
5492 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005493 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5494 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5495 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005496 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005497 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005498
5499 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5500 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5501
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005502 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005503
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005504 global
5505 stats socket /tmp/socket
5506 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005507
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005508 defaults
5509 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005510
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005511 backend bk
5512 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5513 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005514
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005515
5516 Then one can run :
5517
5518 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5519
5520 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5521
5522 1
5523 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5524 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5525 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5526
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005527 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005528
5529 global
5530 stats socket /tmp/socket
5531 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5532
5533 defaults
5534 load-server-state-from-file local
5535
5536 backend bk
5537 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5538 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5539
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005540
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005541 Then one can run :
5542
5543 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5544
5545 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5546
5547 1
5548 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5549 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5550 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5551
5552 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5553 "show servers state"
5554
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005555
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005556log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005557log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5558 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005559no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005560 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5562 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005563
5564 Prefix :
5565 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5566 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5567 prefix does not allow arguments.
5568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005569 Arguments :
5570 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5571 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5572 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5573 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5574 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5575 parameter.
5576
5577 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5578 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5579
5580 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5581 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5582 standard syslog port).
5583
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005584 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5585 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5586 standard syslog port).
5587
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005588 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5589 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5590 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005591 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005592
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005593 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5594 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5595 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5596 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5597 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5598 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5599 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5600 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5601 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5602 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5603 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5604 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5605 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5606 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5607 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5608 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005609 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5610 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005611
5612 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5613 and "fd@2", see above.
5614
5615 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5616 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005617
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005618 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5619 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5620 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5621 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5622 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5623 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5624 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5625 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5626 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5627 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005628 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005629
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005630 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5631 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5632 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5633 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5634 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5635
5636 <sample_size>
5637 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5638 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5639 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5640 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5641 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5642
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005643 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5644 one of the following :
5645
5646 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5647 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5648
5649 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5650 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5651
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005652 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5653 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5654 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5655 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5656 systemd logger consumes.
5657
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005658 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5659 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5660 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5661 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5662
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005663 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5664
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005665 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5666 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5667 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5668
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005669 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5670 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5671 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5672 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005673
5674 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5675 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5676 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005677 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5678 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5679 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5680 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5681 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005682
5683 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5684
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005685 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5686 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5687 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005688
5689 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5690 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5691 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5692 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5693
5694 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5695 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005696
5697 Example :
5698 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005699 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5700 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5701 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005702 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5703 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005704 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005705
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005706
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005707log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005708 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5709 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5710 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005711
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005712 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5713 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5714 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5715 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5716 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005717
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005718 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5719 "option httplog" directives.
5720
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005721log-format-sd <string>
5722 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5723 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5724 yes | yes | yes | no
5725
5726 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5727 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5728 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5729 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5730 which covers the log format string in depth.
5731
5732 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5733 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5734
5735 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5736 log format to "rfc5424".
5737
5738 Example :
5739 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5740
5741
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005742log-tag <string>
5743 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5745 yes | yes | yes | yes
5746
5747 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5748 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5749 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5750 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5751 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5752 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5753 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5754 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5755 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005756
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005757max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5758 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5759 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5760 yes | no | yes | yes
5761
5762 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5763 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5764 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5765 servers.
5766
5767 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5768 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5769 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5770 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5771 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005772 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005773 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5774 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5775 picking a different server.
5776
5777 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5778 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5779 even if they have to be queued.
5780
5781 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5782 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5783
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005784max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5785 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5786 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5787 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005788
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005789maxconn <conns>
5790 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5792 yes | yes | yes | no
5793 Arguments :
5794 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5795 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5796 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5797 closes.
5798
5799 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5800 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5801 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5802 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005803 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5804 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5805 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5806 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005807
5808 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5809 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5810 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5811
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005812 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5813 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005814
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005815 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5816
5817
5818mode { tcp|http|health }
5819 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5821 yes | yes | yes | yes
5822 Arguments :
5823 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5824 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5825 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5826 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5827
5828 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5829 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5830 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5831 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5832 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5833
5834 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005835 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5836 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5837 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5838 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5839 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5840 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5841 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005842
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005843 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5844 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5845 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005846
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005847 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005848 defaults http_instances
5849 mode http
5850
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005851 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005852
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005853
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005854monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005855 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005858 Arguments :
5859 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5860 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005861 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005862 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5863 backend and its backup.
5864
5865 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5866 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5867 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5868 servers in a list of backends.
5869
5870 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5871 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5872 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5873 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5874 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5875 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5876 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005877 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5878 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005879
5880 Example:
5881 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005882 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005883 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5884 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5885 monitor-uri /site_alive
5886 monitor fail if site_dead
5887
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005888 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005889
5890
5891monitor-net <source>
5892 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5894 yes | yes | yes | no
5895 Arguments :
5896 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5897 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5898 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5899 followed by a mask.
5900
5901 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5902 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005903 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005904 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5905
5906 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5907 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5908 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5909 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005910 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5911 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5912 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005913
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005914 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5915 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5916 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5917 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5918 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5919 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005920
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005921 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5922 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005923
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005924 Example :
5925 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5926 frontend www
5927 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5928
5929 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5930
5931
5932monitor-uri <uri>
5933 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5935 yes | yes | yes | no
5936 Arguments :
5937 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5938 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5939
5940 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5941 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5942 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5943 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5944 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5945 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5946 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5947 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5948
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005949 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5950 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5951 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5952 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5953 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5954 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5955 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5956 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005957
5958 Example :
5959 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5960 frontend www
5961 mode http
5962 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5963
5964 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005966
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005967option abortonclose
5968no option abortonclose
5969 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5971 yes | no | yes | yes
5972 Arguments : none
5973
5974 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5975 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5976 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5977 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005978 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005979 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5980 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5981 encountered while delivering the response.
5982
5983 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5984 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5985 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5986 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5987 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5988 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005989 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005990 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005991 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005992 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5993 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5994 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5995
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005996 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5997 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005998 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5999 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6000 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6001 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6002 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6003 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006004 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006005
6006 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6007 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6008
6009 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6010
6011
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006012option accept-invalid-http-request
6013no option accept-invalid-http-request
6014 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
6015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6016 yes | yes | yes | no
6017 Arguments : none
6018
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006019 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006020 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006021 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006022 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6023 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6024 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6025 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6026 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006027 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
6028 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
6029 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
6030 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006031 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006032 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02006033 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
6034 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
6035 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006036
6037 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6038 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6039 been confirmed.
6040
6041 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6042 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01006043 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
6044 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006045 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6046
6047 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6048 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6049
6050 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
6051 stats socket.
6052
6053
6054option accept-invalid-http-response
6055no option accept-invalid-http-response
6056 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
6057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6058 yes | no | yes | yes
6059 Arguments : none
6060
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006061 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006062 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006063 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006064 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
6065 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
6066 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
6067 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
6068 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02006069 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
6070 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
6071 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006072
6073 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
6074 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
6075 been confirmed.
6076
6077 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
6078 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
6079 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
6080 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
6081
6082 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6083 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6084
6085 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
6086 stats socket.
6087
6088
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006089option allbackups
6090no option allbackups
6091 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
6092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6093 yes | no | yes | yes
6094 Arguments : none
6095
6096 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
6097 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
6098 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
6099 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
6100 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
6101 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
6102 order between the backup servers anymore.
6103
6104 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
6105 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
6106
6107 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6108 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6109
6110
6111option checkcache
6112no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08006113 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6115 yes | no | yes | yes
6116 Arguments : none
6117
6118 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
6119 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006120 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006121 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6122 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006123 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006124
6125 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006126 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006127 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006128 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6129 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006130 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006131 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006132 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6133 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006134 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006135 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6136 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006137 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006138 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6139 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6140 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6141 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6142 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6143 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6144 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6145 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6146 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6147
6148 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006149 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006150 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006151 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006152 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6153
6154 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6155 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006156 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006157 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006158
6159 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6160 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6161
6162
6163option clitcpka
6164no option clitcpka
6165 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6167 yes | yes | yes | no
6168 Arguments : none
6169
6170 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6171 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006172 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006173 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6174
6175 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6176 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6177 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6178 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6179
6180 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6181 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6182 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6183 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6184 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6185
6186 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6187
6188 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6189 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6190 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6191
6192 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6193 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6194
6195 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6196
6197
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006198option contstats
6199 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6201 yes | yes | yes | no
6202 Arguments : none
6203
6204 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6205 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6206 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6207 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006208 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6209 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6210 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6211 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6212 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006213
6214
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006215option dontlog-normal
6216no option dontlog-normal
6217 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6219 yes | yes | yes | no
6220 Arguments : none
6221
6222 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6223 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6224 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6225 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6226 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6227 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6228 logged.
6229
6230 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6231 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6232 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006234 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006235 logging.
6236
6237
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006238option dontlognull
6239no option dontlognull
6240 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6242 yes | yes | yes | no
6243 Arguments : none
6244
6245 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6246 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6247 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6248 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6249 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6250 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006251 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6252 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6253 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006254
6255 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006256 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006257 would not be logged.
6258
6259 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6260 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6261
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006262 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6263 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006264
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006265
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006266option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006267 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6269 yes | yes | yes | yes
6270 Arguments :
6271 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6272 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006273 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006274 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006275
6276 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6277 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6278 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6279 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6280 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6281 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6282 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006283 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6284 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6285 possible that the client has already brought one.
6286
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006287 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006288 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006289 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006290 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006291 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006292 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006293
6294 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6295 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6296 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6297 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6298 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6299 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6300 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6301
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006302 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6303 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6304 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6305 are under the control of the end-user.
6306
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006307 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006308 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6309 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006310 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6311 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6312 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006313
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006314 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006315 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6316 frontend www
6317 mode http
6318 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6319
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006320 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6321 backend www
6322 mode http
6323 option forwardfor header X-Client
6324
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006325 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006326 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006327
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006328
Christopher Fauleta99ff4d2019-07-22 16:18:24 +02006329option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6330no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
6331 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
6332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6333 yes | yes | yes | no
6334 Arguments : none
6335
6336 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6337 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6338 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6339 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6340 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6341 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6342 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6343
6344 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
6345 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
6346 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
6347 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6348 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
6349 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6350 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6351 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
6352 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6353 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6354
6355 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
6356
6357 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6358 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6359
6360 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
6361 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6362
6363
6364option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6365no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
6366 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
6367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6368 yes | no | yes | yes
6369 Arguments : none
6370
6371 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
6372 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
6373 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
6374 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
6375 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
6376 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
6377 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
6378
6379 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
6380 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
6381 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
6382 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
6383 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
6384 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
6385 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
6386 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
6387 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
6388 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
6389
6390 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
6391
6392 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6393 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6394
6395 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
6396 "h1-case-adjust-file".
6397
6398
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006399option http-buffer-request
6400no option http-buffer-request
6401 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6403 yes | yes | yes | yes
6404 Arguments : none
6405
6406 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6407 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6408 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6409 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6410 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6411 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6412 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6413 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006414 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006415 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6416 default.
6417
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006418 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006419
6420
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006421option http-ignore-probes
6422no option http-ignore-probes
6423 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6425 yes | yes | yes | no
6426 Arguments : none
6427
6428 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6429 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6430 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6431 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6432 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6433 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6434 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6435 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6436 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006437 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6438 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006439 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6440
6441 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6442 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6443 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6444 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6445 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6446 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6447 are often the only way to detect them.
6448
6449 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6450 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6451
6452 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6453
6454
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006455option http-keep-alive
6456no option http-keep-alive
6457 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6459 yes | yes | yes | yes
6460 Arguments : none
6461
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006462 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6463 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006464 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6465 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6466 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6467 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6468 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006469
6470 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6471 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006472 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6473 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6474 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6475 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6476 situations where this option may be useful :
6477
6478 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006479 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006480
6481 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6482 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6483
6484 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6485 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6486 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6487 request.
6488
6489 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6490 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006491 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6492 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6493 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006494
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006495 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6496 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6497 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6498 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6499 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6500 not set.
6501
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006502 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006503 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6504 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006505
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006506 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006507 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006508 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006509
6510
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006511option http-no-delay
6512no option http-no-delay
6513 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6515 yes | yes | yes | yes
6516 Arguments : none
6517
6518 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6519 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6520 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6521 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6522 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6523 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6524 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6525 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6526 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6527 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6528 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6529 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6530 affected.
6531
6532 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6533 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6534 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6535 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6536 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6537 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6538 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6539 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6540 latency environments.
6541
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006542 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6543
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006544
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006545option http-pretend-keepalive
6546no option http-pretend-keepalive
6547 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6548 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006549 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006550 Arguments : none
6551
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006552 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006553 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6554 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6555 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6556 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6557 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6558 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6559 consider the response complete.
6560
6561 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6562 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6563 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6564 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006565 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006566 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6567
6568 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6569 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6570 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6571 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6572 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6573 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6574 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6575
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006576 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6577 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6578 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6579 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6580 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6581 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006582
6583 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6584 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006586 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006587 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006588
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006589
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006590option http-server-close
6591no option http-server-close
6592 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6594 yes | yes | yes | yes
6595 Arguments : none
6596
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006597 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6598 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6599 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6600 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006601 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6602 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6603 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6604 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6605 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6606 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6607 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6608 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6609 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6610 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6611 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006612
6613 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6614 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6615 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6616 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006617 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6618 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006619
6620 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6621 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006622 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6623 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6624 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006625
6626 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6627 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6628
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006629 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6630 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006631
6632
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006633option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6634no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6635 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006637 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006638 Arguments : none
6639
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006640 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6641 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6642 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6643
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006644 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6645 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6646 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6647 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006648 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006649
6650 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006651 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006652 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6653 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6654 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6655 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6656 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6657 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6658 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006659
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006660 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6661 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6662 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6663 backend.
6664
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006665 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6666 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6667
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006668 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6669 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006670
6671
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006672option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006673no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006674 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6676 yes | yes | yes | no
6677 Arguments : none
6678
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006679 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006680 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6681 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6682 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6683 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6684 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6685 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6686
6687 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6688 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006689 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6690 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6691 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006692
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006693 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6694 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6695 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6696 front of an existing proxy.
6697
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006698 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6699
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006700 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006701
6702
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006703option http-use-htx
6704no option http-use-htx
6705 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6707 yes | yes | yes | yes
6708 Arguments : none
6709
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006710 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006711 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006712 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6713 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6714 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6715 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6716 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006717
6718 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6719 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6720 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6721 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006722 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6723 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6724 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6725 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006726
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006727 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6728 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6729 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6730 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6731 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006732
6733 See also : "mode http"
6734
6735
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006736option httpchk
6737option httpchk <uri>
6738option httpchk <method> <uri>
6739option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6740 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6742 yes | no | yes | yes
6743 Arguments :
6744 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6745 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6746 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6747 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6748 ones.
6749
6750 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6751 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6752 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6753
6754 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6755 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6756 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6757 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6758 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6759
6760 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6761 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6762 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6763 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6764 the lack of any response.
6765
6766 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6767
6768 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6769 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6770 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6771
6772 Examples :
6773 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6774 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6775 backend https_relay
6776 mode tcp
6777 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6778 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6779
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006780 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6781 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6782 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006783
6784
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006785option httpclose
6786no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006787 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6789 yes | yes | yes | yes
6790 Arguments : none
6791
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006792 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6793 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6794 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6795 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006796 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006797
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006798 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6799 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006800 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006801 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6802 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006803
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006804 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6805 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6806 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006807
6808 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6809 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006810 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006811 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6812 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6813 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006814
6815 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6816 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6817
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006818 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006819
6820
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006821option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006822 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006824 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006825 Arguments :
6826 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6827 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6828 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006829 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006830 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006831
6832 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6833 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6834 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6835 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6836 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6837 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6838 ports.
6839
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006840 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6841 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006842
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006843 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006845 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006846
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006847
6848option http_proxy
6849no option http_proxy
6850 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6852 yes | yes | yes | yes
6853 Arguments : none
6854
6855 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6856 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6857 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6858 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6859 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6860
6861 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6862 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006863 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6864 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006865
6866 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6867 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6868
6869 Example :
6870 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6871 backend direct_forward
6872 option httpclose
6873 option http_proxy
6874
6875 See also : "option httpclose"
6876
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006877
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006878option independent-streams
6879no option independent-streams
6880 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6882 yes | yes | yes | yes
6883 Arguments : none
6884
6885 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6886 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6887 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6888 receive data or not.
6889
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006890 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006891 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6892 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6893 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6894 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6895 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6896 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6897 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6898 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6899 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6900 socket buffers.
6901
6902 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6903 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6904 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6905 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6906 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6907
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006908 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006909 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6910 deprecated.
6911
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006912 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006913
6914
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006915option ldap-check
6916 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6918 yes | no | yes | yes
6919 Arguments : none
6920
6921 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6922 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6923 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6924 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6925
6926 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6927 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6928
6929 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6930 configure it.
6931
6932 Example :
6933 option ldap-check
6934
6935 See also : "option httpchk"
6936
6937
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006938option external-check
6939 Use external processes for server health checks
6940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6941 yes | no | yes | yes
6942
6943 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6944 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6945 command".
6946
6947 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6948
6949 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6950
6951
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006952option log-health-checks
6953no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006954 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6956 yes | no | yes | yes
6957 Arguments : none
6958
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006959 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6960 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6961 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006962
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006963 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6964 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6965 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6966 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6967 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6968
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006969 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006970 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006971
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006972 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6973 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6974 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006975
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006976
6977option log-separate-errors
6978no option log-separate-errors
6979 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6981 yes | yes | yes | no
6982 Arguments : none
6983
6984 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6985 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6986 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6987 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6988 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6989 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6990 provides very important information.
6991
6992 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6993 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6994 error logs.
6995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006996 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006997 logging.
6998
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006999
7000option logasap
7001no option logasap
7002 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
7003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7004 yes | yes | yes | no
7005 Arguments : none
7006
7007 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
7008 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
7009 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
7010 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
7011 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
7012 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
7013 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007014 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007015 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
7016 bytes are expected to be transferred.
7017
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007018 Examples :
7019 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7020 mode http
7021 option httplog
7022 option logasap
7023 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7024
7025 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7026 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7027 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7028 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007030 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007031 logging.
7032
7033
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007034option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007035 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7037 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007038 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007039 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7040 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02007041 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007042
7043 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7044 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007045 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007046 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7047 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7048 in the MySQL table, like this :
7049
7050 USE mysql;
7051 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7052 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7053
7054 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007055 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007056 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
7057 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
7058 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
7059 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
7060 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
7061 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
7062 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
7063
7064 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
7065 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007066
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02007067 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007068
7069 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
7070 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
7071 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7072 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007073 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
7074 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007075
7076 See also: "option httpchk"
7077
7078
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007079option nolinger
7080no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007081 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007082 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7083 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007084 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007085
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007086 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007087 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
7088 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
7089 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
7090 connections.
7091
7092 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
7093 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
7094 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
7095 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
7096 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
7097 this too.
7098
7099 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
7100 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
7101 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
7102
7103 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
7104 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
7105 for servers.
7106
7107 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7108 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7109
7110
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007111option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
7112 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
7113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7114 yes | yes | yes | yes
7115 Arguments :
7116 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7117 matching <network>
7118 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
7119 header name.
7120
7121 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
7122 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
7123 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
7124 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
7125 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
7126 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
7127 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
7128 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
7129 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7130 possible that the client has already brought one.
7131
7132 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
7133 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
7134 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
7135 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
7136 header and requires different one.
7137
7138 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7139 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7140 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7141 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7142 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7143 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7144 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7145
7146 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
7147 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7148 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
7149 both are defined.
7150
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007151 Examples :
7152 # Original Destination address
7153 frontend www
7154 mode http
7155 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
7156
7157 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
7158 backend www
7159 mode http
7160 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
7161
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007162 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007163
7164
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007165option persist
7166no option persist
7167 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
7168 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7169 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007170 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007171
7172 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
7173 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
7174 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
7175 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
7176 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
7177 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
7178 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
7179 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
7180 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
7181 redirected to another valid server.
7182
7183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7185
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007186 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007187
7188
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01007189option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
7190 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7192 yes | no | yes | yes
7193 Arguments :
7194 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7195 PostgreSQL server.
7196
7197 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7198 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7199 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7200 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7201
7202 See also: "option httpchk"
7203
7204
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007205option prefer-last-server
7206no option prefer-last-server
7207 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7208 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7209 yes | no | yes | yes
7210 Arguments : none
7211
7212 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7213 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7214 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7215 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7216 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7217 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7218 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7219 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7220 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007221 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7222 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007223 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7224 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7225 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007226 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7227 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7228 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007229
7230 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7231 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7232
7233 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7234
7235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007236option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007237option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007238no option redispatch
7239 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7240 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7241 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007242 Arguments :
7243 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7244 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7245 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007246 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007247 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007248 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007249 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7250 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7251 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7252
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007253
7254 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7255 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7256 be able to access the service anymore.
7257
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007258 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7259 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007260
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007261 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007262 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7263 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007265 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7266 "redisp" keywords.
7267
7268 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7269 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7270
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007271 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007272
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007273
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007274option redis-check
7275 Use redis health checks for server testing
7276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7277 yes | no | yes | yes
7278 Arguments : none
7279
7280 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7281 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7282 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7283 find the "+PONG" response message.
7284
7285 Example :
7286 option redis-check
7287
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007288 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007289
7290
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007291option smtpchk
7292option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7293 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7295 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007296 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007297 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007298 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007299 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7300
7301 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7302 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7303 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7304
7305 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7306 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7307 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7308 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7309 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7310 dead server.
7311
7312 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7313 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007314 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007315 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7316
7317 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7318 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7319 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7320 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007321 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007322
7323 Example :
7324 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7325
7326 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007328
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007329option socket-stats
7330no option socket-stats
7331
7332 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7334 yes | yes | yes | no
7335
7336 Arguments : none
7337
7338
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007339option splice-auto
7340no option splice-auto
7341 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7343 yes | yes | yes | yes
7344 Arguments : none
7345
7346 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7347 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007348 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007349 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007350 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007351 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7352 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7353 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7354 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7355
7356 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7357 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7358 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7359 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7360 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7361 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7362 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7363 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7364 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7365 keyword.
7366
7367 Example :
7368 option splice-auto
7369
7370 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7371 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7372
7373 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7374 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7375
7376
7377option splice-request
7378no option splice-request
7379 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7381 yes | yes | yes | yes
7382 Arguments : none
7383
7384 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007385 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007386 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7387 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7388 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7389 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7390
7391 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7392
7393 Example :
7394 option splice-request
7395
7396 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7397 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7398
7399 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7400 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7401
7402
7403option splice-response
7404no option splice-response
7405 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7407 yes | yes | yes | yes
7408 Arguments : none
7409
7410 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007411 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007412 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7413 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7414 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7415 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7416
7417 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7418
7419 Example :
7420 option splice-response
7421
7422 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7423 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7424
7425 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7426 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7427
7428
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007429option spop-check
7430 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7432 no | no | no | yes
7433 Arguments : none
7434
7435 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7436 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7437 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7438 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7439
7440 Example :
7441 option spop-check
7442
7443 See also : "option httpchk"
7444
7445
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007446option srvtcpka
7447no option srvtcpka
7448 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7450 yes | no | yes | yes
7451 Arguments : none
7452
7453 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7454 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007455 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007456 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7457
7458 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7459 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7460 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7461 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7462
7463 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7464 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7465 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7466 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7467 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7468
7469 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7470
7471 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7472 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7473 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7474
7475 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7476 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7477
7478 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7479
7480
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007481option ssl-hello-chk
7482 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7484 yes | no | yes | yes
7485 Arguments : none
7486
7487 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7488 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7489 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7490 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7491 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7492 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7493 hello message.
7494
7495 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7496 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7497 messages, which is appreciable.
7498
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007499 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7500 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7501 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007502
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007503 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7504
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007505
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007506option tcp-check
7507 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7509 yes | no | yes | yes
7510
7511 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7512 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7513
7514 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7515 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7516 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7517
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007518 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007519 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7520 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7521 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7522 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7523 only.
7524
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007525 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007526 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7527 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7528 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7529 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7530
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007531 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007532 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7533 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007534 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007535 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7536 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7537 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7538 the respective protocols.
7539 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007540 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007541
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007542 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7543 script.
7544
7545 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7546 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7547 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7548 The "comment" is of course optional.
7549
7550
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007551 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007552 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007553 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007554 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007555
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007556 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007557 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007558 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007559
7560 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7561 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007562 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007563 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007564 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007565 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007566 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007567 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007568 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7569 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007570 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007571 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7572 tcp-check expect string +OK
7573
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007574 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007575 (send many headers before analyzing)
7576 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007577 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007578 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7579 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7580 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7581 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007582 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007583
7584
7585 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7586
7587
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007588option tcp-smart-accept
7589no option tcp-smart-accept
7590 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7592 yes | yes | yes | no
7593 Arguments : none
7594
7595 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7596 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7597 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7598 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7599 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7600 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7601
7602 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7603 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7604 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7605 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7606
7607 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7608 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7609 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007610 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007611
7612 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7613 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7614 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7615
7616 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7617 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7618 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7619
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007620 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7621
7622
7623option tcp-smart-connect
7624no option tcp-smart-connect
7625 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7627 yes | no | yes | yes
7628 Arguments : none
7629
7630 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7631 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7632 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7633 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7634 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7635
7636 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7637 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7638 complex.
7639
7640 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7641 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7642 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7643
7644 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7645 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7646
7647 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7648
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007649
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007650option tcpka
7651 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7653 yes | yes | yes | yes
7654 Arguments : none
7655
7656 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7657 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007658 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007659 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7660
7661 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7662 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7663 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7664 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7665
7666 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7667 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7668 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7669 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7670 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7671
7672 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7673
7674 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7675 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7676 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7677 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7678 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7679 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7680 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7681 backends.
7682
7683 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7684
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007685
7686option tcplog
7687 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007689 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007690 Arguments : none
7691
7692 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7693 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7694 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7695 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7696 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7697 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7698 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7699 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7700
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007701 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007703 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007704
7705
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007706option transparent
7707no option transparent
7708 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007710 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007711 Arguments : none
7712
7713 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7714 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7715 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7716 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7717 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7718 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7719 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7720 appropriate server.
7721
7722 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7723 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7724
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007725 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007726 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007727
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007728
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007729external-check command <command>
7730 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7732 yes | no | yes | yes
7733
7734 Arguments :
7735 <command> is the external command to run
7736
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007737 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7738
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007739 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007740
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007741 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7742 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7743 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7744 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7745 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7746 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007747
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007748 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7749
7750 Environment variables :
7751 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7752 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7753
7754 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7755
7756 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7757
7758 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7759 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7760 for a UNIX socket).
7761
7762 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7763
7764 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7765
7766 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7767
7768 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7769
7770 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7771
7772 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7773 socket).
7774
7775 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7776 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7777
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007778 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7779
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007780 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7781 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7782 failed.
7783
7784 Example :
7785 external-check command /bin/true
7786
7787 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7788
7789
7790external-check path <path>
7791 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7793 yes | no | yes | yes
7794
7795 Arguments :
7796 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7797
7798 The default path is "".
7799
7800 Example :
7801 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7802
7803 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7804 "external-check command"
7805
7806
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007807persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007808persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007809 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7811 yes | no | yes | yes
7812 Arguments :
7813 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007814 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7815 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007816
7817 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7818 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007819 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007820 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7821 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7822 forwarded to this server.
7823
7824 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7825 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7826 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007827 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007828 a single "listen" section.
7829
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007830 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7831 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7832 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7833
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007834 Example :
7835 listen tse-farm
7836 bind :3389
7837 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7838 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7839 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7840 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7841 persist rdp-cookie
7842 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007843 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007844 balance rdp-cookie
7845 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7846 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7847
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007848 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7849 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007850
7851
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007852rate-limit sessions <rate>
7853 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7855 yes | yes | yes | no
7856 Arguments :
7857 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7858 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7859
7860 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7861 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7862 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7863 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7864 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7865 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7866
7867 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7868 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7869 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7870 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7871
7872 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7873 listen smtp
7874 mode tcp
7875 bind :25
7876 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007877 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007878
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007879 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7880 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7881 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007882
7883 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7884
7885
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007886redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7887redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7888redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007889 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7891 no | yes | yes | yes
7892
7893 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007894 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007895
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007896 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007897 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007898 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7899 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7900 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007901
7902 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7903 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7904 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7905 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7906 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007907 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7908 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7909 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7910 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007911
7912 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7913 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7914 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7915 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7916 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7917 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007918 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007919 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007920 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7921 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7922 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007923
7924 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007925 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7926 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7927 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007928 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007929 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7930 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7931 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7932 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007933
7934 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007935 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007936
7937 - "drop-query"
7938 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7939 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7940 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7941 with a location-type redirect.
7942
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007943 - "append-slash"
7944 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7945 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7946 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7947 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7948
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007949 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7950 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7951 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7952 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7953 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7954 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7955 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7956
7957 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7958 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7959 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7960 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7961 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7962 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7963 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007964
7965 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7966 acl clear dst_port 80
7967 acl secure dst_port 8080
7968 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007969 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007970 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007971 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7972
7973 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007974 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7975 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7976 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007977 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007978
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007979 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7980 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7981 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7982
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007983 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007984 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007985
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007986 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007987 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7988 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7989 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007991 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007992
7993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007994redisp (deprecated)
7995redispatch (deprecated)
7996 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7997 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7998 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007999 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008000
8001 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8002 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8003 be able to access the service anymore.
8004
8005 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
8006 redistribute them to a working server.
8007
8008 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
8009 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8010 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008012 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
8013 "option redispatch" instead.
8014
8015 See also : "option redispatch"
8016
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008017
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008018reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008019 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
8020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8021 no | yes | yes | yes
8022 Arguments :
8023 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8024 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008025 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008026
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008027 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8028 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8029
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008030 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8031 the last header of an HTTP request.
8032
8033 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8034 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8035 responses.
8036
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01008037 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
8038 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
8039 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
8040
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008041 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
8042 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008043
8044
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008045reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8046reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008047 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8049 no | yes | yes | yes
8050 Arguments :
8051 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8052 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8053 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8054 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8055 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8056 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
8057 ignores case.
8058
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008059 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8060 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8061
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008062 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8063 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
8064 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8065 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008066 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008067
8068 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8069 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8070
8071 Example :
8072 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
8073 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8074 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8075
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008076 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
8077 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008078
8079
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008080reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8081reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008082 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
8083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8084 no | yes | yes | yes
8085 Arguments :
8086 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8087 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8088 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8089 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8090 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
8091 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
8092
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008093 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8094 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8095
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008096 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
8097 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
8098 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
8099 next servers.
8100
8101 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8102 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8103 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8104
8105 Example :
8106 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
8107 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
8108 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
8109
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008110 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
8111 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008112
8113
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008114reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8115reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008116 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
8117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8118 no | yes | yes | yes
8119 Arguments :
8120 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8121 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8122 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8123 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8124 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8125 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
8126 case.
8127
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008128 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8129 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8130
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008131 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8132 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
8133 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
8134 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008135 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008136
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008137 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008138 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008139 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008140
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008141 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8142 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8143
8144 Example :
8145 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
8146 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8147 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8148
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008149 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8150 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008151
8152
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008153reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8154reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008155 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
8156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8157 no | yes | yes | yes
8158 Arguments :
8159 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8160 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8161 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8162 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8163 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8164 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
8165 case.
8166
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008167 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8168 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8169
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008170 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8171 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
8172 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
8173 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8174
8175 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8176 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
8177
8178 Example :
8179 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
8180 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
8181 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
8182 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
8183
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008184 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
8185 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008186
8187
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008188reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8189reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008190 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8192 no | yes | yes | yes
8193 Arguments :
8194 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8195 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8196 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8197 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8198 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8199 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8200
8201 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8202 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8203 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8204 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008205 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008206
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008207 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8208 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8209
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008210 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8211 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8212 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8213
8214 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8215 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8216 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8217 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8218 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8219
8220 Example :
8221 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008222 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008223 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8224 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8225
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008226 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8227 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008228
8229
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008230reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8231reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008232 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8234 no | yes | yes | yes
8235 Arguments :
8236 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8237 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8238 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8239 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8240 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8241 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8242 ignores case.
8243
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008244 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8245 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8246
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008247 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8248 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008249 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8250 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8251 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008252 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8253 not set.
8254
8255 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8256 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8257 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8258 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8259 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8260
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008261 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008262 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008263 # block all others.
8264 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8265 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8266
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008267 # block bad guys
8268 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8269 reqitarpit . if badguys
8270
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008271 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8272 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008273
8274
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008275retries <value>
8276 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8278 yes | no | yes | yes
8279 Arguments :
8280 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8281 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8282 default value is 3.
8283
8284 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8285 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8286 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8287
8288 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008289 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8290 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008291
8292 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8293 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8294
8295 See also : "option redispatch"
8296
8297
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008298retry-on [list of keywords]
8299 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8300 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8301 yes | no | yes | yes
8302 Arguments :
8303 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8304 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8305 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8306 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8307
8308 none never retry
8309
8310 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8311 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8312
8313 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8314 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8315 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8316 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8317 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8318 processing the request.
8319
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008320 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8321 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8322 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8323 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8324 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8325 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8326 overflow attack for example).
8327
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008328 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8329 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8330 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8331 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8332 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8333 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8334 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8335 amplify denial of service attacks.
8336
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008337 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8338 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8339 considered to be safe to retry.
8340
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008341 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8342 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8343 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8344 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8345
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008346 all-retryable-errors
8347 retry request for any error that are considered
8348 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8349 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8350 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8351
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008352 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8353 not cumulative.
8354
8355 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8356 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8357 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8358 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8359
8360 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8361 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8362 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8363 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8364 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8365 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8366 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8367 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8368 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8369 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8370 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8371 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8372
8373 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8374 should not use this directive.
8375
8376 The default is "conn-failure".
8377
8378 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8379
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008380rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008381 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8383 no | yes | yes | yes
8384 Arguments :
8385 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8386 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008387 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008388
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008389 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8390 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8391
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008392 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8393 the last header of an HTTP response.
8394
8395 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8396 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8397 responses.
8398
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008399 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8400 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008401
8402
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008403rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8404rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008405 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8407 no | yes | yes | yes
8408 Arguments :
8409 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8410 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8411 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8412 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8413 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8414 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8415 ignores case.
8416
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008417 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8418 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8419
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008420 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8421 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008422 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008423 client.
8424
8425 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8426 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8427 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8428
8429 Example :
8430 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008431 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008432
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008433 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8434 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008435
8436
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008437rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8438rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008439 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8441 no | yes | yes | yes
8442 Arguments :
8443 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8444 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8445 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8446 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8447 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8448 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8449 ignores case.
8450
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008451 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8452 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8453
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008454 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8455 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8456 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8457 case-sensitive.
8458
8459 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008460 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8461 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8462 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008463
8464 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8465 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8466
8467 Example :
8468 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8469 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8470
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008471 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8472 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008473
8474
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008475rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8476rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008477 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8479 no | yes | yes | yes
8480 Arguments :
8481 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8482 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8483 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8484 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8485 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8486 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8487 ignores case.
8488
8489 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8490 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8491 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8492 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008493 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008494
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008495 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8496 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8497
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008498 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8499 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8500 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8501
8502 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8503 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8504 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8505 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8506 are not case-sensitive.
8507
8508 Example :
8509 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8510 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8511
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008512 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8513 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008514
8515
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008516server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008517 Declare a server in a backend
8518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8519 no | no | yes | yes
8520 Arguments :
8521 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008522 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008523 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008524
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008525 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8526 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8527 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8528 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008529 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8530 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8531 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8532 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8533 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008534 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8535 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8536 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8537 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8538 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8539 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8540 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008541 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008542 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8543 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8544 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8545 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8546 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8547 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008548 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8549 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008550 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8551 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008552
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008553 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008554 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8555 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8556 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8557 adding this value to the client's port.
8558
8559 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8560 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008561 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008562
8563 Examples :
8564 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8565 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008566 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008567 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8568 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8569 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008570
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008571 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8572 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8573 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8574 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8575 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8576
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008577 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8578 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008579
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008580server-state-file-name [<file>]
8581 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8582 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8583 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8584 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8585 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8586 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8587
8588 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8589 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8590
8591 global
8592 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8593
Willy Tarreau750bb0c2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01008594 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008595 load-server-state-from-file
8596
8597 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8598 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008599
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008600server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8601 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8602 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8604 no | no | yes | yes
8605
8606 Arguments:
8607 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8608
8609 <num | range>
8610 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8611 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8612 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8613 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8614
8615 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8616
8617 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8618
8619 <params*>
8620 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8621 keyword.
8622
8623 Examples:
8624 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8625 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8626 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8627
8628 # or
8629 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8630
8631 # would be equivalent to:
8632 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8633 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8634 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8635
8636
8637
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008638source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008639source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008640source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008641 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8643 yes | no | yes | yes
8644 Arguments :
8645 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8646 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008647
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008648 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008649 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8650 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8651 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8652 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8653 supported prefixes are :
8654 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8655 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8656 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008657 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008658 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8659 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008660
8661 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8662 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008663 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8664 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8665 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008666
8667 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8668 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8669 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8670 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8671 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8672 <addr>.
8673
8674 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8675 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8676 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8677 port.
8678
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008679 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8680 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8681 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8682 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008683 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008684 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8685 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8686 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8687 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8688 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8689 HTTP header.
8690
8691 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8692 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008693 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008694 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8695 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8696 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8697 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8698 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8699 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8700 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8701
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008702 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8703 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8704 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8705 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8706 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8707 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8708
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008709 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8710 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8711 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8712 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8713
8714 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8715 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8716 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8717 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8718 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8719 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8720
8721 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8722 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8723 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8724 there are two methods :
8725
8726 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8727 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8728 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8729 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8730 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8731 of the client ranges may be used.
8732
8733 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8734 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8735 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8736 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8737 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8738 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8739 same session.
8740
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008741 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8742 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8743 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008744 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008745
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008746 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8747
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008748 Examples :
8749 backend private
8750 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8751 source 192.168.1.200
8752
8753 backend transparent_ssl1
8754 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8755 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8756
8757 backend transparent_ssl2
8758 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8759 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8760 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8761
8762 backend transparent_ssl3
8763 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8764 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8765 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8766
8767 backend transparent_smtp
8768 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8769 # with Tproxy version 4.
8770 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8771
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008772 backend transparent_http
8773 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8774 # proxy.
8775 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8776
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008777 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008778 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008780
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008781srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8782 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8784 yes | no | yes | yes
8785 Arguments :
8786 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8787 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8788 as explained at the top of this document.
8789
8790 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8791 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8792 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8793 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8794 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8795 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8796 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8797
8798 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8799 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8800 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8801 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8802 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008803 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008804 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008805 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008806
8807 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8808 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8809 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8810 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8811 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8812 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8813
8814 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8815 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8816
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008817 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8818 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008819
8820
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008821stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8822 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008824 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008825
8826 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8827 matched.
8828
8829 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8830 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8831
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008832 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8833 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008834 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008835
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008836 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8837 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8838 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8839 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008840
8841 Example :
8842 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8843 backend stats_localhost
8844 stats enable
8845 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8846
8847 Example :
8848 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8849 backend stats_auth
8850 stats enable
8851 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8852 stats admin if TRUE
8853
8854 Example :
8855 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8856 userlist stats-auth
8857 group admin users admin
8858 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8859 group readonly users haproxy
8860 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8861
8862 backend stats_auth
8863 stats enable
8864 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8865 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8866 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8867 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8868
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008869 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8870 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8871 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008872
8873
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008874stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8875 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008877 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008878 Arguments :
8879 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8880
8881 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8882
8883 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8884 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8885 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8886 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8887 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8888 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8889
8890 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8891 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8892 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008893 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008894
8895 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8896 report using "stats scope".
8897
8898 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8899 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8900 unobvious parameters.
8901
8902 Example :
8903 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8904 backend public_www
8905 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8906 stats enable
8907 stats hide-version
8908 stats scope .
8909 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008910 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008911 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8912 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8913
8914 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8915 backend private_monitoring
8916 stats enable
8917 stats uri /admin?stats
8918 stats refresh 5s
8919
8920 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8921
8922
8923stats enable
8924 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008926 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008927 Arguments : none
8928
8929 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8930 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8931 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8932 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8933 - stats auth : no authentication
8934 - stats scope : no restriction
8935
8936 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8937 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8938 unobvious parameters.
8939
8940 Example :
8941 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8942 backend public_www
8943 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8944 stats enable
8945 stats hide-version
8946 stats scope .
8947 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008948 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008949 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8950 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8951
8952 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8953 backend private_monitoring
8954 stats enable
8955 stats uri /admin?stats
8956 stats refresh 5s
8957
8958 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8959
8960
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008961stats hide-version
8962 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008964 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008965 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008966
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008967 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8968 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8969 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8970 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8971 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8972 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008974 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8975 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8976 unobvious parameters.
8977
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008978 Example :
8979 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8980 backend public_www
8981 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008982 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008983 stats hide-version
8984 stats scope .
8985 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008986 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008987 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8988 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008989
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008990 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8991 backend private_monitoring
8992 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008993 stats uri /admin?stats
8994 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008995
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008996 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008997
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008998
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008999stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9000 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9001 Access control for statistics
9002
9003 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9004 no | no | yes | yes
9005
9006 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9007 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9008 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9009 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9010 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9011 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9012
9013 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9014 instance.
9015
9016 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9017 about ACL usage.
9018
9019
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009020stats realm <realm>
9021 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009023 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009024 Arguments :
9025 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9026 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9027 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9028
9029 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9030 using a backslash ('\').
9031
9032 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9033 only related to authentication.
9034
9035 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9036 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9037 unobvious parameters.
9038
9039 Example :
9040 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9041 backend public_www
9042 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9043 stats enable
9044 stats hide-version
9045 stats scope .
9046 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009047 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009048 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9049 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9050
9051 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9052 backend private_monitoring
9053 stats enable
9054 stats uri /admin?stats
9055 stats refresh 5s
9056
9057 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9058
9059
9060stats refresh <delay>
9061 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009063 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009064 Arguments :
9065 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9066 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9067 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9068 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9069 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9070 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9071
9072 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9073 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9074 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9075 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9076
9077 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9078 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9079 unobvious parameters.
9080
9081 Example :
9082 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9083 backend public_www
9084 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9085 stats enable
9086 stats hide-version
9087 stats scope .
9088 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009089 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009090 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9091 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9092
9093 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9094 backend private_monitoring
9095 stats enable
9096 stats uri /admin?stats
9097 stats refresh 5s
9098
9099 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9100
9101
9102stats scope { <name> | "." }
9103 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009105 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009106 Arguments :
9107 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9108 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9109 section in which the statement appears.
9110
9111 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9112 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9113 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9114 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9115 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9116 exists.
9117
9118 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9119 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9120 unobvious parameters.
9121
9122 Example :
9123 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9124 backend public_www
9125 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9126 stats enable
9127 stats hide-version
9128 stats scope .
9129 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009130 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009131 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9132 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9133
9134 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9135 backend private_monitoring
9136 stats enable
9137 stats uri /admin?stats
9138 stats refresh 5s
9139
9140 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9141
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009142
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009143stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009144 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009146 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009147
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009148 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009149 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9150
9151 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9152 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9153
9154 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9155 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009156 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009157
9158 Example :
9159 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9160 backend private_monitoring
9161 stats enable
9162 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9163 stats uri /admin?stats
9164 stats refresh 5s
9165
9166 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9167 global section.
9168
9169
9170stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009171 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9173 yes | yes | yes | yes
9174 Arguments : none
9175
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009176 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009177 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9178 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9179 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9180 - IP (socket, server)
9181 - cookie (backend, server)
9182
9183 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9184 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009185 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009186
9187 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9188
9189
9190stats show-node [ <name> ]
9191 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009193 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009194 Arguments:
9195 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9196 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9197
9198 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9199 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009200 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009201
9202 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9203 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9204 unobvious parameters.
9205
9206 Example:
9207 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9208 backend private_monitoring
9209 stats enable
9210 stats show-node Europe-1
9211 stats uri /admin?stats
9212 stats refresh 5s
9213
9214 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9215 section.
9216
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009217
9218stats uri <prefix>
9219 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009221 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009222 Arguments :
9223 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9224 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9225 query string.
9226
9227 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9228 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9229 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9230 possible to reach it in the application.
9231
9232 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009233 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009234 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9235 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9236 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9237 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9238
9239 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9240 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9241 an address or a port to statistics only.
9242
9243 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9244 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9245 unobvious parameters.
9246
9247 Example :
9248 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9249 backend public_www
9250 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9251 stats enable
9252 stats hide-version
9253 stats scope .
9254 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009255 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009256 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9257 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9258
9259 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9260 backend private_monitoring
9261 stats enable
9262 stats uri /admin?stats
9263 stats refresh 5s
9264
9265 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9266
9267
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009268stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9269 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009271 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009272
9273 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009274 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009275 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009276 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009277 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9278
9279 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9280 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9281 the "stick-table" statement.
9282
9283 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9284 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9285 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9286 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9287 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9288
9289 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9290 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9291 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9292 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9293 transformation rules.
9294
9295 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9296 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9297 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9298 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9299 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9300 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9301 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9302
9303 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9304 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9305 ACL based conditions.
9306
9307 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9308 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9309 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9310 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9311
9312 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9313 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9314 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9315 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9316
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009317 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9318 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009319 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009320
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009321 Example :
9322 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9323 # last 30 minutes
9324 backend pop
9325 mode tcp
9326 balance roundrobin
9327 stick store-request src
9328 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9329 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9330 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9331
9332 backend smtp
9333 mode tcp
9334 balance roundrobin
9335 stick match src table pop
9336 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9337 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9338
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009339 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009340 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009341
9342
9343stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9344 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9346 no | no | yes | yes
9347
9348 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9349 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9350 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9351 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9352
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009353 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9354 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009355 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009356
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009357 Examples :
9358 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009359 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009360
9361 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9362 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9363 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9364
9365
9366 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9367 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9368 backend http
9369 mode http
9370 balance roundrobin
9371 stick on src table https
9372 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9373 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9374 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9375
9376 backend https
9377 mode tcp
9378 balance roundrobin
9379 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9380 stick on src
9381 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9382 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9383
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009384 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009385
9386
9387stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9388 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9390 no | no | yes | yes
9391
9392 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009393 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009394 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009395 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009396 server is selected.
9397
9398 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9399 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9400 the "stick-table" statement.
9401
9402 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9403 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9404 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9405 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9406 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9407 address.
9408
9409 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9410 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9411 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9412 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9413 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9414 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9415 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9416 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9417 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9418 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9419
9420 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9421 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9422 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9423 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9424 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9425 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9426 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9427
9428 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9429 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9430 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9431 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9432
9433 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9434 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9435 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9436 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9437 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9438 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009439 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9440 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9441 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9442 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9443 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9444 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009445
9446 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9447 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9448 the request.
9449
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009450 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9451 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009452 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009453
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009454 Example :
9455 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9456 # last 30 minutes
9457 backend pop
9458 mode tcp
9459 balance roundrobin
9460 stick store-request src
9461 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9462 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9463 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9464
9465 backend smtp
9466 mode tcp
9467 balance roundrobin
9468 stick match src table pop
9469 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9470 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9471
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009472 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009473 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009474
9475
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009476stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009477 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9478 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009479 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009481 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009482
9483 Arguments :
9484 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9485 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9486 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9487 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9488
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009489 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9490 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9491 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9492 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9493
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009494 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9495 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9496 instance.
9497
9498 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9499 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9500 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9501 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9502 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9503 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009504 to 32 characters.
9505
9506 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9507 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9508 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009509 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009510 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9511 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009512
9513 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009514 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9515 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009516 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9517 increase.
9518
9519 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009520 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9521 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9522 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009523
9524 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9525 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9526 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9527 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009528 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009529 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9530 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9531 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9532 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9533 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9534 parameter (see below).
9535
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009536 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9537 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9538 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9539 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9540 soft restart.
9541
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009542 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9543 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009544
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009545 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9546 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9547 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9548 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009549 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009550 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009551 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9552 if not expiration delay is specified.
9553
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009554 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9555 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9556 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9557 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009558 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9559 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9560 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9561 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9562 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9563 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9564 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9565 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9566 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9567 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9568 types and their arguments.
9569
9570 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9571 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9572 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9573 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9574
9575 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9576 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9577 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009578 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009579
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009580 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9581 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9582 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009583 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009584 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009585 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009586
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009587 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9588 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9589 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9590 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9591
9592 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9593 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9594 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9595 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9596 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9597 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9598
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009599 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9600 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9601 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9602 they were received.
9603
9604 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9605 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9606 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9607 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9608 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9609
9610 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9611 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9612 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9613 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9614 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9615
9616 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9617 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9618 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9619
9620 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9621 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9622 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9623 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9624 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9625
9626 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9627 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9628 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9629 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9630 the client side.
9631
9632 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9633 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9634 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9635 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9636 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9637 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9638 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9639
9640 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9641 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9642 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9643 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9644 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9645 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009646 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009647
9648 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9649 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9650 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9651 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9652 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9653 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9654
9655 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009656 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009657 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9658 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9659
9660 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9661 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9662 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9663 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9664 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9665 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9666 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9667 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9668 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9669 recommended for better fairness.
9670
9671 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009672 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009673 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9674 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9675
9676 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9677 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9678 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9679 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9680 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9681 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9682 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9683 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9684 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9685 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009686
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009687 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9688 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009689 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9690 reference it.
9691
9692 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9693 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009694 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9695 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9696 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009697
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009698 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9699 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9700 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9701 something that can be ignored.
9702
9703 Example:
9704 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9705 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9706 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9707 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9708
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009709 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009710 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009711
9712
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009713stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009714 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009715 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9716 no | no | yes | yes
9717
9718 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009719 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009720 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009721 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009722 server is selected.
9723
9724 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9725 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9726 the "stick-table" statement.
9727
9728 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9729 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9730 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9731 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9732
9733 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9734 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9735 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9736 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9737 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9738 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009739 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009740 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9741 rules.
9742
9743 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9744 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9745 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9746 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9747 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9748 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9749 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9750
9751 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9752 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9753 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9754 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9755
9756 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9757 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9758 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9759 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9760 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9761 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009762 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9763 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9764 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9765 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9766 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9767 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9768 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9769 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9770 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009771
9772 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9773
9774 Example :
9775 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9776 backend https
9777 mode tcp
9778 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009779 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009780 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009781
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009782 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9783 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9784
9785 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9786 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9787 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9788
9789 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9790 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009791
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009792 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9793 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9794 # at offset 44.
9795
9796 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9797 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9798
9799 # Learn on response if server hello.
9800 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009801
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009802 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9803 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9804
9805 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9806 extraction.
9807
9808
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009809tcp-check connect [params*]
9810 Opens a new connection
9811 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9812 no | no | yes | yes
9813
9814 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9815 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9816 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9817
9818 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9819 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9820 of the sequence.
9821
9822 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9823 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9824 do.
9825
9826 Parameters :
9827 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9828 use the TCP connection.
9829
9830 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9831 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9832 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9833
9834 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9835
9836 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9837
9838 Examples:
9839 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9840 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9841 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9842 option tcp-check
9843 tcp-check connect
9844 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9845 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9846 tcp-check send \r\n
9847 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9848 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9849 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9850 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9851 tcp-check send \r\n
9852 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9853 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9854
9855 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9856 option tcp-check
9857 tcp-check connect port 110
9858 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9859 tcp-check connect port 143
9860 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9861 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9862
9863 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9864
9865
9866tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009867 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009868 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9869 no | no | yes | yes
9870
9871 Arguments :
9872 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9873 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9874 binary.
9875 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9876 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9877 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9878
9879 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9880 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9881 with the usual backslash ('\').
9882 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009883 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009884 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9885 used upper or lower case.
9886
9887
9888 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9889
9890 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9891 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9892 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9893 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9894 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9895 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9896 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9897 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9898
9899 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9900 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9901 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9902 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9903 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9904 expression.
9905
9906 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9907 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9908 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9909 this exact hexadecimal string.
9910 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9911
9912 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9913 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9914 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9915 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9916 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9917 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9918 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9919 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9920 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9921 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9922 the null character.
9923
9924 Examples :
9925 # perform a POP check
9926 option tcp-check
9927 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9928
9929 # perform an IMAP check
9930 option tcp-check
9931 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9932
9933 # look for the redis master server
9934 option tcp-check
9935 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009936 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009937 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9938 tcp-check expect string role:master
9939 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9940 tcp-check expect string +OK
9941
9942
9943 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9944 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9945
9946
9947tcp-check send <data>
9948 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9950 no | no | yes | yes
9951
9952 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9953 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9954
9955 Examples :
9956 # look for the redis master server
9957 option tcp-check
9958 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9959 tcp-check expect string role:master
9960
9961 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9962 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9963
9964
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009965tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9966 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009967 tcp health check
9968 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9969 no | no | yes | yes
9970
9971 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9972 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009973 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009974 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9975 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9976 hexadecimal string.
9977 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9978
9979 Examples :
9980 # redis check in binary
9981 option tcp-check
9982 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9983 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9984
9985
9986 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9987 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9988
9989
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009990tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9991 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9993 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009994 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009995 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9996 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009997
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009998 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009999
10000 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10001 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010002 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10003 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10004 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10005 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10006 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10007 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010008
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010009 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10010 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10011 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10012 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010013
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010014 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010015 - accept :
10016 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10017 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10018 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010019
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010020 - reject :
10021 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10022 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10023 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10024 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10025 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10026 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10027 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10028 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10029 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10030 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10031 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010032 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010033
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010034 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10035 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10036 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10037 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10038 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10039 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10040 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10041 hosts.
10042
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010043 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10044 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10045 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10046 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10047 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10048 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10049 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10050 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10051
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010052 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10053 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10054 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10055 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10056 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10057 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10058 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10059 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10060 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010061 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10062 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010063
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010064 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010065 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010066 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10067 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10068 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010069 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010070 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10071 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10072 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10073 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10074 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10075 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10076 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10077 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010078
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010079 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010080 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010081 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010082 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010083 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10084 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10085 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010086
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010087 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10088 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10089 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10090 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010091
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010092 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10093 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10094 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10095 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10096 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010097 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10098 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10099 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10100 layer7 information is extracted.
10101
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010102 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10103 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10104 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10105 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10106 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010107
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010108 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10109 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10110 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10111 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10112
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010113 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10114 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10115 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10116 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10117
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010118 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
10119 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10120 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10121 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10122 continues.
10123
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010124 - set-src <expr> :
10125 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10126 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10127 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010128 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010129
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010130 Arguments:
10131 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10132 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010133
10134 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010135 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10136
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010137 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10138 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010139
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010140 - set-src-port <expr> :
10141 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10142 expression.
10143
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010144 Arguments:
10145 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10146 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010147
10148 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010149 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10150
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010151 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10152 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10153 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010154
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010155 - set-dst <expr> :
10156 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10157 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10158 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10159 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10160 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10161
10162 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10163 followed by some converters.
10164
10165 Example:
10166
10167 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10168 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10169
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010170 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10171 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10172
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010173 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10174 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10175 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10176 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10177
10178
10179 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10180 followed by some converters.
10181
10182 Example:
10183
10184 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10185
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010186 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10187 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10188 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10189
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010190 - "silent-drop" :
10191 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010192 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010193 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10194 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10195 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10196 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10197 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010198 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10199 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010200 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10201 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010202 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010203 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10204 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10205 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10206 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10207
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010208 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10209 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10210 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010211
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010212 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10213 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10214 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010216 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010217 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010218 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010219
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010220 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10221 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10222 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010223
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010224 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010225 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10226 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010227
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010228 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10229
10230 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10231
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010232 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10233
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010234 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010235
10236
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010237tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10238 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010240 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010241 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010242 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10243 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010244
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010245 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010246
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010247 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010248 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10249 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10250 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10251 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010252
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010253 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10254 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10255 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10256 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010257 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10258 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10259 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10260 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10261 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10262 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010263 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010264 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010265
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010266 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10267 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10268 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10269 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010270
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010271 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010272 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010273 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010274 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10275 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010276 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010277 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010278 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010279 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010280 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010281 - set-dst <expr>
10282 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010283 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010284 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010285 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010286 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010287 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010288
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010289 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10290 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010291 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10292 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010293
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010294 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10295 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10296 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10297 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10298 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10299 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010301 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010302 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10303 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010304
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010305 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010306 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10307 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10308 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10309 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010310 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10311 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10312 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010313
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010314 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010315 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10316 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10317 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010318
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010319 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10320 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10321
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010322 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010323 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10324 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010325
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010326 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10327 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010328 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010329 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10330 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010331 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010332 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010333 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010334 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10335 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010336 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010337 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10338 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010339
10340 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10341 followed by some converters.
10342
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010343 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10344 <var-name>.
10345
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010346 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10347 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10348 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10349 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10350 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10351
10352 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10353 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10354 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10355 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10356 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10357 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10358 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10359 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10360 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10361 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10362 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10363
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010364 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10365 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10366 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10367 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10368 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10369
10370 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10371
10372 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10373
Christopher Faulet6bd406e2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010374 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
10375 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
10376 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
10377 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
10378 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
10379 evaluated.
10380
10381 Example:
10382 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
10383
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010384 Example:
10385
10386 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010387 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010388
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010389 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010390 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10391 # and reject everything else.
10392 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10393 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010394 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010395 tcp-request content reject
10396
10397 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010398 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10399 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10400 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010401 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010402
10403 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10404 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10405 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010406 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010407 tcp-request content reject
10408
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010409 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010410 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010411 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010412 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010413 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10414 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010415
10416 Example:
10417 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10418 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010419 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010420
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010421 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010422 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010423
10424 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010425 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010426 # protecting all our sites
10427 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010428 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10429 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010430 ...
10431 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10432
10433 backend http_dynamic
10434 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010435 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010436 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010437 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010438 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010439 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010440 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010442 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010443
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010444 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10445 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010446
10447
10448tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10449 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010451 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010452 Arguments :
10453 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10454 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10455 as explained at the top of this document.
10456
10457 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10458 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10459 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10460 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10461 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10462
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010463 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10464 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10465 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10466 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10467
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010468 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10469 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010470 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010471 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010472 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10473 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10474 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10475 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010476
10477 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10478 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10479 it pass through unaffected.
10480
10481 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10482 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10483 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010484 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010485 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10486 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010487 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10488 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10489 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010490
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010491 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010492 "timeout client".
10493
10494
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010495tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10496 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10498 no | no | yes | yes
10499 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010500 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10501 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010502
10503 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10504
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010505 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010506 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10507 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010508 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10509 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010510
10511 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10512
10513 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10514 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10515 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10516 inserted.
10517
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010518 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010519 - accept :
10520 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10521 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10522 the rules evaluation.
10523
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010524 - close :
10525 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10526 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10527 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10528 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10529 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10530 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010531 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010532 protocols.
10533
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010534 - reject :
10535 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10536 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010537 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010538
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010539 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10540 Sets a variable.
10541
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010542 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10543 Unsets a variable.
10544
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010545 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10546 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10547 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10548 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10549
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010550 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10551 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10552 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10553 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10554
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010555 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10556 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10557 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10558 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10559 continues.
10560
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010561 - "silent-drop" :
10562 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010563 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010564 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10565 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10566 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10567 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10568 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010569 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10570 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010571 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10572 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010573 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010574 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10575 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10576 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10577 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10578
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010579 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10580 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10581
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010582 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10583 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10584 for changing the default action to a reject.
10585
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010586 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10587 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10588 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10589 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010590 period.
10591
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010592 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10593 declared inline.
10594
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010595 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10596 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010597 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010598 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10599 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010600 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010601 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010602 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010603 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10604 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010605 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010606 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10607 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010608
10609 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10610 followed by some converters.
10611
10612 Example:
10613
10614 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10615
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010616 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10617 <var-name>.
10618
10619 Example:
10620
10621 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10622
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010623 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10624 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10625 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10626 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10627 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10628
10629 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10630
10631 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10632
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010633 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10634
10635 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10636
10637
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010638tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10639 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10641 no | yes | yes | no
10642 Arguments :
10643 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10644 below.
10645
10646 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10647
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010648 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010649 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10650 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10651 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10652 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10653 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10654 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10655 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010656 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010657 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10658 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10659 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10660 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10661 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10662 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10663 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10664 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10665 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10666 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10667 instead.
10668
10669 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10670 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10671 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10672 rules which may be inserted.
10673
10674 Several types of actions are supported :
10675 - accept : the request is accepted
10676 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10677 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10678 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010679 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010680 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10681 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010682 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010683 - silent-drop
10684
10685 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10686 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10687 sections for a complete description.
10688
10689 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10690 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10691 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10692
10693 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10694 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10695 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10696 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10697 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10698
10699 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10700 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10701
10702 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10703 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10704 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10705
10706 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10707 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10708 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10709
10710 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10711 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10712 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10713
10714 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10715 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10716 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10717
10718 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10719
10720 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10721
10722
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010723tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10724 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10726 no | no | yes | yes
10727 Arguments :
10728 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10729 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10730 as explained at the top of this document.
10731
10732 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10733
10734
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010735timeout check <timeout>
10736 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10737 established.
10738
10739 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10740 yes | no | yes | yes
10741 Arguments:
10742 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10743 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10744 as explained at the top of this document.
10745
10746 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10747 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010748 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010749 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010750 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10751 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10752 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010753
10754 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10755 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10756
10757 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10758 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010759 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010760
10761 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10762 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10763 forget about it.
10764
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010765 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10766 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010767
10768
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010769timeout client <timeout>
10770timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10771 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10773 yes | yes | yes | no
10774 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010775 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010776 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10777 as explained at the top of this document.
10778
10779 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10780 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10781 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010782 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10783 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10784 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10785 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010786 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10787 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10788 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010789 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010790 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010791 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10792 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010793 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10794 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010795
10796 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10797 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10798 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10799 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010800 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010801 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10802
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010803 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010804
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010805 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10806 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10807 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10808
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010809 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10810 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010811
10812
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010813timeout client-fin <timeout>
10814 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10816 yes | yes | yes | no
10817 Arguments :
10818 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10819 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10820 as explained at the top of this document.
10821
10822 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10823 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10824 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10825 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10826 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10827 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10828 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010829 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10830 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10831 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010832
10833 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10834 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10835 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10836
10837 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10838
10839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010840timeout connect <timeout>
10841timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10842 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10844 yes | no | yes | yes
10845 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010846 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010847 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10848 as explained at the top of this document.
10849
10850 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010851 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010852 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010853 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010854 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10855 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010856
10857 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10858 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10859 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10860 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010861 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010862 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10863
10864 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10865 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10866 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10867
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010868 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10869 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010870
10871
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010872timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10873 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10875 yes | yes | yes | yes
10876 Arguments :
10877 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10878 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10879 as explained at the top of this document.
10880
10881 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10882 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10883 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10884 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10885 once the request has started to present itself.
10886
10887 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10888 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10889 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10890 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10891 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10892
10893 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10894 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10895 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10896 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10897
10898 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10899 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010900 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010901 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10902 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010903 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010904
10905 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10906 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10907 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10908 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10909
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010910 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10911 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010912 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10913
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010914 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10915
10916
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010917timeout http-request <timeout>
10918 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010920 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010921 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010922 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010923 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10924 as explained at the top of this document.
10925
10926 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10927 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10928 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10929 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10930 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10931 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10932 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010933 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10934 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10935 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10936 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010937 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010938 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10939 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010940
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010941 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10942 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10943 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10944 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10945 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010946 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010947
10948 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10949 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010950 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010951 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10952 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10953
10954 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010955 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10956 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10957 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010958
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010959 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010960 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010961
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010962
10963timeout queue <timeout>
10964 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10966 yes | no | yes | yes
10967 Arguments :
10968 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10969 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10970 as explained at the top of this document.
10971
10972 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10973 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10974 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10975 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10976 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10977
10978 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10979 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10980 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10981 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10982
10983 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10984
10985
10986timeout server <timeout>
10987timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10988 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10990 yes | no | yes | yes
10991 Arguments :
10992 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10993 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10994 as explained at the top of this document.
10995
10996 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10997 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10998 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10999 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11000 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11001 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11002 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11003
11004 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11005 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11006 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11007 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11008 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011009 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011010 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011011 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11012 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011013 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11014 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011015
11016 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11017 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11018 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11019 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011020 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011021 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11022
11023 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
11024 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
11025 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
11026
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011027 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011028
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011029
11030timeout server-fin <timeout>
11031 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11033 yes | no | yes | yes
11034 Arguments :
11035 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11036 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11037 as explained at the top of this document.
11038
11039 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11040 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11041 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11042 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11043 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11044 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11045 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11046 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11047 situations, it should not be needed.
11048
11049 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11050 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11051 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11052
11053 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11054
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011055
11056timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011057 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11059 yes | yes | yes | yes
11060 Arguments :
11061 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11062 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11063 as explained at the top of this document.
11064
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011065 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
11066 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
11067 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
11068 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011069
11070 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11071 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11072 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11073 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011074 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011075
11076 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
11077
11078
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011079timeout tunnel <timeout>
11080 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11082 yes | no | yes | yes
11083 Arguments :
11084 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11085 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11086 as explained at the top of this document.
11087
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011088 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011089 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11090 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11091 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011092 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11093 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011094 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11095 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11096 specified.
11097
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011098 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11099 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11100 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11101 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11102 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11103 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11104 state.
11105
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011106 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11107 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11108 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11109 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011110 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011111
11112 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11113 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11114 forget about it.
11115
11116 Example :
11117 defaults http
11118 option http-server-close
11119 timeout connect 5s
11120 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011121 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011122 timeout server 30s
11123 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11124
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011125 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011126
11127
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011128transparent (deprecated)
11129 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011131 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011132 Arguments : none
11133
11134 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11135 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11136 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11137 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11138 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11139 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11140 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11141 appropriate server.
11142
11143 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11144
11145 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11146 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11147
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011148 See also: "option transparent"
11149
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011150unique-id-format <string>
11151 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11153 yes | yes | yes | no
11154 Arguments :
11155 <string> is a log-format string.
11156
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011157 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11158 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11159 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11160 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011161
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011162 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11163 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11164 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11165 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11166 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11167 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11168 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11169 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011170
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011171 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11172 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011173
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011174 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011175
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011176 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011177
11178 will generate:
11179
11180 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11181
11182 See also: "unique-id-header"
11183
11184unique-id-header <name>
11185 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11187 yes | yes | yes | no
11188 Arguments :
11189 <name> is the name of the header.
11190
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011191 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11192 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011193
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011194 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011195
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011196 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011197 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11198
11199 will generate:
11200
11201 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11202
11203 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011204
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011205use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011206 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11208 no | yes | yes | no
11209 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011210 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11211 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011212
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011213 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11214 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011215
11216 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11217 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11218 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011219 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011220 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011221 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11222 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011223
11224 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11225 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11226 assign the backend.
11227
11228 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11229 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11230 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11231 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11232 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11233 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11234
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011235 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011236 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011237 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11238 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11239 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11240
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011241 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11242 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11243 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11244 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11245 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11246 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11247 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11248 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11249 cannot be forced from the request.
11250
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011251 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011252 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11253 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11254
11255 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11256 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011257
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011258
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011259use-server <server> if <condition>
11260use-server <server> unless <condition>
11261 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11263 no | no | yes | yes
11264 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011265 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011266
11267 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11268
11269 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11270 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11271 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11272
11273 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11274 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11275 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11276 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11277 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11278 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11279 matches will assign the server.
11280
11281 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11282 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11283 with the next rules until one matches.
11284
11285 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11286 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11287 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11288 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11289
11290 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11291 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11292 stripped.
11293
11294 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11295 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11296 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11297 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11298
11299 Example :
11300 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11301 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11302 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11303 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11304 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11305 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011306 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011307 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11308 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11309
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011310 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011311
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011312
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100113135. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011314--------------------------
11315
11316The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11317depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11318settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11319written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11320described in this section.
11321
11322
113235.1. Bind options
11324-----------------
11325
11326The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11327as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11328no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11329parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11330while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11331provided immediately after the setting name.
11332
11333The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11334
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011335accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11336 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11337 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11338 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11339 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11340 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11341 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11342 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11343 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11344 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011345 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11346 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11347 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011348
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011349accept-proxy
11350 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011351 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11352 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011353 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11354 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11355 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11356 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011357 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011358 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11359 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011360 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11361 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011362
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011363allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011364 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011365 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011366 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011367 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11368 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011369
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011370alpn <protocols>
11371 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11372 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11373 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011374 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011375 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011376 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11377 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11378 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11379 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11380 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11381 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11382 preference, like below :
11383
11384 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011385
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011386backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011387 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011388 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11389
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011390curves <curves>
11391 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11392 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11393 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11394 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11395 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11396 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11397
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011398ecdhe <named curve>
11399 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011400 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11401 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011402
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011403ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011404 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11405 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11406 client's certificate.
11407
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011408ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11409 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11410 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11411 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11412 error is ignored.
11413
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011414ca-sign-file <cafile>
11415 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11416 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11417 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11418 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11419 'generate-certificates' for details.
11420
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011421ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011422 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11423 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11424 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11425 'generate-certificates' for details.
11426
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011427ciphers <ciphers>
11428 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11429 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011430 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011431 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011432 information and recommendations see e.g.
11433 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11434 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11435 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11436
11437ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11438 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11439 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11440 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11441 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011442 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11443 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011444
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011445crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11447 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11448 to verify client's certificate.
11449
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011450crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11452 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11453 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11454 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11455 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11456 file.
11457
11458 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11459 are loaded.
11460
11461 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011462 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011463 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11464 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11465 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11466 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011467 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11468 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011469 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011470
11471 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11472 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11473 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11474 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011475 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11476 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011477
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011478 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011479
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011480 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011481 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011482 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11483 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011484 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11485 clients).
11486
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011487 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11488 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11489 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11490 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11491 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11492 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11493 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11494 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11495 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11496 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11497 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11498 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11499 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11500
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011501 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11502 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11503 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11504 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11505 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11506
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011507 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11508 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11509 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11510 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011511
11512 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11513 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11514 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11515 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11516 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11517 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11518 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11519 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11520 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11521
11522 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11523
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011524 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011525 a cert bundle.
11526
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011527 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011528 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11529 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11530 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11531 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11532 provide multi-cert support.
11533
11534 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11535
11536 Filename | CN | SAN
11537 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11538 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011539 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011540 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11541 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11542
11543 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11544 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11545 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11546 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011547 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11548 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11549 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011550
11551 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11552 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11553
11554 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11555 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11556 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11557
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011558crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011559 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011560 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011561 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011562 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011563
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011564crt-list <file>
11565 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011566 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11567 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011568
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011569 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11570
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011571 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11572 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011573 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011574 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011575
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011576 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11577 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11578 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11579 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11580 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11581 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11582 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11583 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011584
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011585 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011586 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011587 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11588 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11589 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011590
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011591 crt-list file example:
11592 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011593 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011594 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011595 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011596
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011597defer-accept
11598 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11599 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11600 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011601 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011602 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11603 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11604 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11605 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11606 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11607 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11608 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11609
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011610expose-fd listeners
11611 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11612 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011613 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11614 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011615 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011616
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011617force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011618 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011619 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011620 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011621 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011622
11623force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011624 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011625 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011626 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011627
11628force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011629 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011630 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011631 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011632
11633force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011634 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011635 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011636 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011637
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011638force-tlsv13
11639 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11640 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011641 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011642
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011643generate-certificates
11644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11645 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11646 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11647 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11648 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11649 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11650 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11651 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11652 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11653 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11654 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11655
11656 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11657 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011658 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011659 certificate is used many times.
11660
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011661gid <gid>
11662 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11663 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11664 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11665 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11666 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11667
11668group <group>
11669 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11670 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11671 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11672 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11673 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11674
11675id <id>
11676 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11677 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11678 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11679 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11680
11681interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011682 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11683 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11684 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11685 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11686 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11687 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011688 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11689 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11690 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11691 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11692 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11693 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011694
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011695level <level>
11696 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11697 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11698 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011699 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011700 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11701 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11702 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011703 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011704 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011705 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011706 all counters).
11707
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011708severity-output <format>
11709 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11710 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11711 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11712 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11713 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11714 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11715 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11716 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11717 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11718 rfc5424 convention.
11719
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011720maxconn <maxconn>
11721 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11722 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11723 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11724 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11725 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11726 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11727 eat all memory.
11728
11729mode <mode>
11730 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11731 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11732 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11733 UNIX sockets.
11734
11735mss <maxseg>
11736 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11737 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11738 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11739 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11740 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11741 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11742 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11743 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11744 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11745 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11746 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11747
11748name <name>
11749 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11750 page.
11751
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011752namespace <name>
11753 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11754 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11755 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11756 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11757
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011758nice <nice>
11759 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11760 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11761 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11762 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11763 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11764 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11765 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11766 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11767 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11768 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11769 one for an RDP socket.
11770
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011771no-ca-names
11772 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11773 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11774
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011775no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011776 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011777 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011778 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011779 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011780 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11781 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011782
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011783no-tls-tickets
11784 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11785 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11786 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011787 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11788 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010011789 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
11790 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
11791 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011792
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011793no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011794 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011795 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011796 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011797 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011798 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11799 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011800
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011801no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011803 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011804 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011805 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011806 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11807 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011808
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011809no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011811 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011812 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011813 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011814 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11815 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011816
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011817no-tlsv13
11818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11819 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11820 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11821 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011822 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11823 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011824
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011825npn <protocols>
11826 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11827 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11828 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011829 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011830 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011831 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11832 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11833 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11834 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11835 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011836
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011837prefer-client-ciphers
11838 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11839 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11840 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011841 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11842 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11843 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011844
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011845process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011846 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011847 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011848 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011849 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11850 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11851 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11852 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011853 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011854 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11855 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11856 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11857 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11858 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011859
11860 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11861
11862 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11863 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11864 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11865 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11866 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11867 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11868 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11869 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011870
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011871proto <name>
11872 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11873 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11874 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11875 in haproxy -vv.
11876 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11877 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011878 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011879 h2" on the bind line.
11880
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011881ssl
11882 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011883 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011884 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11885 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011886 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11887 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011888
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011889ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11890 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11891 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11892 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11893
11894ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11895 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11896 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11897 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11898
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011899strict-sni
11900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11901 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11902 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11903 See the "crt" option for more information.
11904
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011905tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011906 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011907 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11908 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011909 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011910 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11911 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11912 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11913 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11914 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11915 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11916 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11917
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011918tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011919 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011920 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11921 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11922 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11923 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11924 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11925 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11926 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011927 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11928 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11929 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011930
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011931tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11932 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011933 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11934 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11935 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11936 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11937 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11938 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11939 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11940 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11941 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11942 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011943 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11944 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11945
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011946transparent
11947 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11948 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11949 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11950 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11951 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11952 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11953 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11954 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11955 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11956 so check for support with your vendor.
11957
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011958v4v6
11959 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11960 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11961 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11962 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011963 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011964
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011965v6only
11966 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11967 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11968 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011969 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11970 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011971
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011972uid <uid>
11973 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11974 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11975 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11976 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11977 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11978
11979user <user>
11980 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11981 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11982 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11983 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11984 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11985
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011986verify [none|optional|required]
11987 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11988 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11989 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11990 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11991 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011992 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11993 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11994 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11995 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011996
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200119975.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011998------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012000The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12001which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12002arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12003settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12004after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12005Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12006address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012008 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012009 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012010
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012011Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12012keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012014The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012015
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012016addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012017 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012018 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12019 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12020 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12021 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12022 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012023
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012024agent-check
12025 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012026 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012027 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12028 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12029 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012030
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012031 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012032 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012033 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12034 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12035 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012036
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012037 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12038 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12039 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12040 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12041 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012042
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012043 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012044 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012045
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012046 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12047 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12048 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012049
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012050 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12051 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12052 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012053
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012054 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12055 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12056 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12057 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12058 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012059 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012060 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012061
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012062 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12063 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012064
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012065 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12066 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12067 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12068 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12069 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12070 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12071 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12072 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12073 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012074
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012075 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12076 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012077 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12078 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12079 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012080 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012081
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012082 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012083 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012084
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012085agent-send <string>
12086 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12087 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12088 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12089 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12090 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12091
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012092agent-inter <delay>
12093 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12094 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12095
12096 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12097 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12098 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12099 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12100 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12101 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12102 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12103 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12104 of backends use the same servers.
12105
12106 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12107
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012108agent-addr <addr>
12109 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12110
12111 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12112 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12113 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12114 hostname, it will be resolved.
12115
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012116agent-port <port>
12117 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12118
12119 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12120
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012121allow-0rtt
12122 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012123 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12124 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012125
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012126alpn <protocols>
12127 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12128 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12129 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012130 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012131 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12132 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12133 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12134 now obsolete NPN extension.
12135 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12136 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12137
12138 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012140backup
12141 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12142 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12143 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12144 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012145 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12146 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012147
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012148ca-file <cafile>
12149 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12150 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12151 server's certificate.
12152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012153check
12154 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010012155 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
12156 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
12157 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
12158 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
12159 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
12160 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
12161 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090012162 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
12163 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012164 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
12165 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012166
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012167check-send-proxy
12168 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12169 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12170 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12171 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12172 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12173 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12174 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12175
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012176check-alpn <protocols>
12177 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12178 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12179 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12180
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012181check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012182 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012183 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12184 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012185
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012186check-ssl
12187 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12188 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12189 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12190 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012191 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012192 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12193 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012194 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012195 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12196 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012197
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012198check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012199 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012200 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12201 for normal traffic.
12202
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012203ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12205 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12206 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012207 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12208 information and recommendations see e.g.
12209 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12210 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12211 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012212
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012213ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12214 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12215 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12216 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12217 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012218 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12219 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12220 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012222cookie <value>
12223 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12224 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12225 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12226 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12227 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12228 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12229 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12230
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012231crl-file <crlfile>
12232 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12233 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12234 to verify server's certificate.
12235
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012236crt <cert>
12237 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12238 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12239 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12240 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12241 certificate request.
12242
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012243disabled
12244 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12245 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12246 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12247 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12248 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012249 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012250
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012251enabled
12252 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12253 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12254 default value.
12255 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12256 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012257
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012258error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012259 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12260 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12261 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012263 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012265fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012266 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12267 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12268 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12269
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012270force-sslv3
12271 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12272 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012273 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012274 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012275
12276force-tlsv10
12277 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012278 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012279 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012280
12281force-tlsv11
12282 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012283 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012284 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012285
12286force-tlsv12
12287 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012288 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012289 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012290
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012291force-tlsv13
12292 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12293 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012294 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012296id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012297 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12298 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12299 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012300
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012301init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12302 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12303 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012304 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012305 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12306 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12307 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12308 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12309 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12310 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12311 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12312 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12313 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012314 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012315 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12316 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12317 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12318 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12319 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12320 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012321 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012322
12323 Example:
12324 defaults
12325 # never fail on address resolution
12326 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12327
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012328inter <delay>
12329fastinter <delay>
12330downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012331 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12332 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12333 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12334 between checks depending on the server state :
12335
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012336 Server state | Interval used
12337 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12338 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12339 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12340 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12341 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12342 or yet unchecked. |
12343 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12344 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12345 | "inter" otherwise.
12346 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012348 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12349 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12350 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12351 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012352 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12353 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12354 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12355 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12356 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012358maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012359 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12360 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012361 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
12362 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012363 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12364 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12365 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12366 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12367
Tim Duesterhus50cfb312019-11-27 22:35:27 +010012368 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
12369 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
12370 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
12371 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
12372 than 50 concurrent requests.
12373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012374maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012375 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12376 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12377 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12378 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12379 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12380 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12381 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12382
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012383max-reuse <count>
12384 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12385 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12386 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12387 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12388 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12389 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12390 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12391 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12392
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012393minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012394 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12395 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12396 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12397 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12398 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12399 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012400 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012401 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012402
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012403namespace <name>
12404 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12405 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12406 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12407 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12408
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012409no-agent-check
12410 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12411 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12412 default value.
12413 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12414 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12415
12416no-backup
12417 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12418 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12419 default value.
12420 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12421 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12422
12423no-check
12424 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12425 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12426 default value.
12427 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12428 "default-server" "check" setting.
12429
12430no-check-ssl
12431 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12432 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12433 default value.
12434 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12435 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12436
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012437no-send-proxy
12438 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12439 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12440 default value.
12441 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12442 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12443
12444no-send-proxy-v2
12445 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12446 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12447 default value.
12448 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12449 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12450
12451no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12452 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12453 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12454 default value.
12455 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12456 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12457
12458no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12459 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12460 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12461 default value.
12462 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12463 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12464
12465no-ssl
12466 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12467 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12468 default value.
12469 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12470 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12471
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012472no-ssl-reuse
12473 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12474 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12475 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12476 and for paranoid users.
12477
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012478no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012479 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12480 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012481 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012482
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012483 Supported in default-server: No
12484
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012485no-tls-tickets
12486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12487 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12488 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012489 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12490 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012491 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12492 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12493 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012494 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012495
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012496no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012497 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012498 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12499 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012500 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12501 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012502 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012503
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012504 Supported in default-server: No
12505
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012506no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012507 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012508 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12509 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012510 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12511 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012512 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012513
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012514 Supported in default-server: No
12515
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012516no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012517 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012518 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12519 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012520 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12521 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012522 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012523
12524 Supported in default-server: No
12525
12526no-tlsv13
12527 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12528 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12529 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12530 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12531 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012532 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012533
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012534 Supported in default-server: No
12535
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012536no-verifyhost
12537 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12538 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12539 default value.
12540 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12541 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012542
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012543no-tfo
12544 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12545 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12546 default value.
12547 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12548 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12549
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012550non-stick
12551 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12552 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12553 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12554
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012555npn <protocols>
12556 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12557 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12558 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012559 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012560 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12561 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12562 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12563
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012564observe <mode>
12565 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12566 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12567 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12568 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12569 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12570 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012571 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012572
12573 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012575on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012576 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12577 Currently, four modes are available:
12578 - fastinter: force fastinter
12579 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12580 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12581 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12582 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12583
12584 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12585
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012586on-marked-down <action>
12587 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12588 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012589 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12590 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12591 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12592 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12593 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12594 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12595 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12596 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012597
12598 Actions are disabled by default
12599
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012600on-marked-up <action>
12601 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12602 Currently one action is available:
12603 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12604 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12605 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12606 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012607 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12608 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012609 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12610 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12611
12612 Actions are disabled by default
12613
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012614pool-max-conn <max>
12615 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12616 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12617 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12618 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12619 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12620 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12621
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012622pool-purge-delay <delay>
12623 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012624 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012625 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012627port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012628 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12629 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12630 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12631 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12632 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12633 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12634
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012635proto <name>
12636
12637 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12638 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12639 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12640 reported in haproxy -vv.
12641 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12642 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012644redir <prefix>
12645 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12646 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12647 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12648 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12649 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12650 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12651 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12652 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012653 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012654 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012655 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12656 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12657 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12658 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12659
12660 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012662rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012663 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12664 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12665 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12666
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012667resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12668 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12669 server.
12670
12671 Available options:
12672
12673 * allow-dup-ip
12674 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12675 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12676 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12677 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12678 For such case, simply enable this option.
12679 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12680
12681 * prevent-dup-ip
12682 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12683 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12684 same fqdn.
12685 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12686
12687 Example:
12688 backend b_myapp
12689 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12690 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12691 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12692
12693 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12694 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12695 it
12696 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12697 different address
12698
12699 Default value: not set
12700
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012701resolve-prefer <family>
12702 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12703 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12704 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12705 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12706
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012707 Default value: ipv6
12708
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012709 Example:
12710
12711 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012712
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012713resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012714 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012715 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012716 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012717 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12718 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012719 configured network, another address is selected.
12720
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012721 Example:
12722
12723 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012724
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012725resolvers <id>
12726 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12727 hostname.
12728
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012729 Example:
12730
12731 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012732
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012733 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012734
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012735send-proxy
12736 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12737 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12738 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12739 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012740 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12741 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12742 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12743 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12744 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12745 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12746 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12747 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12748 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12749 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012750 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12751 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012752
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012753send-proxy-v2
12754 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12755 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12756 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12757 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012758 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12759 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12760 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12761 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012762
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012763proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12764 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12765 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012766 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12767 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012768 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12769 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012770 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012771
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012772send-proxy-v2-ssl
12773 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12774 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12775 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12776 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12777 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12778 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12779 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012780 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12781 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012782
12783send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12784 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12785 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12786 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12787 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12788 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12789 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12790 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12791 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012792 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12793 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012795slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012796 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12797 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12798 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12799 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12800 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12801 parameters :
12802
12803 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12804 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12805
12806 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12807 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12808 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12809 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12810
12811 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12812 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12813 seen as failed.
12814
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012815sni <expression>
12816 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12817 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12818 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12819 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012820 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12821 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012822 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012823 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12824 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012825
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012826source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012827source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012828source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012829 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12830 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12831 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12832 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12833
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012834 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12835 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12836 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12837 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12838 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12839 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12840 server.
12841
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012842 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12843 specifying the source address without port(s).
12844
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012845ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012846 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12847 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12848 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12849 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12850 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12851 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012852 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12853 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012854
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012855ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12856 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12857 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12858 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12859
12860ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12861 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12862 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12863 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12864
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012865ssl-reuse
12866 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12867 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12868 default value.
12869 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12870 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12871
12872stick
12873 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12874 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12875 default value.
12876 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12877 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012878
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012879socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012880 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012881 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12882 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12883
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012884tcp-ut <delay>
12885 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12886 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12887 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012888 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012889 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12890 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12891 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12892 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12893 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12894 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12895 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12896 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12897 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12898
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012899tfo
12900 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12901 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12902 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12903 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12904 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012905 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012907track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012908 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12909 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12910 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12911 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012912 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12913
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012914tls-tickets
12915 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12916 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12917 default value.
Lukas Tribusd8fd6362020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012918 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12919 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12920 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012921 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke04037d32020-02-13 14:16:16 +010012922 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012923
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012924verify [none|required]
12925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012926 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012927 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12928 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012929 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012930 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12931 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12932 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12933 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12934 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12935 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12936 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12937 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012938
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012939verifyhost <hostname>
12940 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012941 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12942 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12943 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12944 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12945 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12946 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12947 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12948 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012950weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012951 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12952 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12953 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012954 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12955 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12956 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12957 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12958 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12959 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012960
12961
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129625.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12963-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012964
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012965HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12966using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12967configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012968This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12969can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12970workload.
12971This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12972resolution at run time.
12973Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12974carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12975
12976
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200129775.3.1. Global overview
12978----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012979
12980As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12981different steps of the process life:
12982
12983 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12984 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12985 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12986
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012987 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12988 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012989
12990A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12991 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12992 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12993 resolution to know this new IP.
12994
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012995When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012996HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012997SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12998from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12999will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13000will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013001
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013002A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013003 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013004 first valid response.
13005
13006 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13007 servers return an error.
13008
13009
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200130105.3.2. The resolvers section
13011----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013012
13013This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013014HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13015contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013016
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013017When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13018uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13019is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13020answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13021
13022When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013023used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013024
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013025 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13026 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13027 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013028
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013029 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13030 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013031
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013032 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13033 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13034 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013035
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013036For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13037following scenarios are possible:
13038
13039 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13040 ignored
13041
13042 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13043 applied
13044
13045 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13046 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13047
13048 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13049 retries the query with a new type
13050
13051 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13052 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013053
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013054As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13055a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013056<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013057
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013058
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013059resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013060 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013061
13062A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13063
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013064accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013065 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013066 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013067 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13068 by RFC 6891)
13069
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013070 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13071
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013072nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13073 DNS server description:
13074 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13075 <ip> : IP address of the server
13076 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13077
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013078parse-resolv-conf
13079 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13080 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13081 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13082
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013083hold <status> <period>
13084 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13085 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013086 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013087 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013088 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13089 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13090 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13091
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013092 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013093
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013094resolve_retries <nb>
13095 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13096 giving up.
13097 Default value: 3
13098
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013099 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13100 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13101 type.
13102
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013103timeout <event> <time>
13104 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13105 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13106 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013107 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13108 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013109 Default value: 1s
13110 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013111 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013112 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013113 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13114 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13115
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013116 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013117
13118 resolvers mydns
13119 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13120 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013121 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013122 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013123 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013124 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013125 hold other 30s
13126 hold refused 30s
13127 hold nx 30s
13128 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013129 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013130 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013131
13132
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131336. HTTP header manipulation
13134---------------------------
13135
13136In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
13137response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
13138request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
13139which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013140against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013141
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010013142If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
13143to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
13144but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
13145HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
13146stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
13147because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
13148a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
13149still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020013150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013151This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
13152in section 4.2 :
13153
13154 - reqadd <string>
13155 - reqallow <search>
13156 - reqiallow <search>
13157 - reqdel <search>
13158 - reqidel <search>
13159 - reqdeny <search>
13160 - reqideny <search>
13161 - reqpass <search>
13162 - reqipass <search>
13163 - reqrep <search> <replace>
13164 - reqirep <search> <replace>
13165 - reqtarpit <search>
13166 - reqitarpit <search>
13167 - rspadd <string>
13168 - rspdel <search>
13169 - rspidel <search>
13170 - rspdeny <search>
13171 - rspideny <search>
13172 - rsprep <search> <replace>
13173 - rspirep <search> <replace>
13174
13175With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
13176is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
13177parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
13178prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
13179Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
13180
13181 \t for a tab
13182 \r for a carriage return (CR)
13183 \n for a new line (LF)
13184 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
13185 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
13186 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
13187 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
13188 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
13189
13190The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
13191portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
13192above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
13193regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
131949 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
13195is very common to users of the "sed" program.
13196
13197The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
13198after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
13199
13200Notes related to these keywords :
13201---------------------------------
13202 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
13203 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
13204 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
13205
13206 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
13207 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
13208 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
13209
13210 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
13211 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
13212 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
13213 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
13214 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
13215
13216 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13217 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13218 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13219 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13220 useless headers before adding new ones.
13221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013222 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013223 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13224
13225 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13226 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13227 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13228
13229 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13230 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013231 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013232
13233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132347. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13235----------------------------------
13236
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013237HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013238client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13239The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13240these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13241but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13242data called patterns.
13243
13244
132457.1. ACL basics
13246---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013247
13248The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13249content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13250from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13251simple :
13252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013253 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013254 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013255 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13256 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013258The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13259adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013260
13261In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013263 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013264
13265This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13266Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13267and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013268an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13269conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13270as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13271are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013272
13273ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13274'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13275which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13276
13277There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13278performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013280The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13281specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13282this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013283methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13284ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013285
13286Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13287 - boolean
13288 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13289 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13290 - string
13291 - data block
13292
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013293Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13294converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13295would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13296The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13297which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13298
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013299Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13300keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13301fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13302which are summarized in the table below :
13303
13304 +---------------------+-----------------+
13305 | Sample or converter | Default |
13306 | output type | matching method |
13307 +---------------------+-----------------+
13308 | boolean | bool |
13309 +---------------------+-----------------+
13310 | integer | int |
13311 +---------------------+-----------------+
13312 | ip | ip |
13313 +---------------------+-----------------+
13314 | string | str |
13315 +---------------------+-----------------+
13316 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13317 +---------------------+-----------------+
13318
13319Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13320matching method, see below.
13321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013322The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13323 - boolean
13324 - integer or integer range
13325 - IP address / network
13326 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13327 - regular expression
13328 - hex block
13329
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013330The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13331
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013332 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13333 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013334 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013335 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013336 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013337 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013338 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013340The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13341read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13342if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13343lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13344will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13345beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13346a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13347lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13348exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13349
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013350The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13351parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13352ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13353a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13354check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13355
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013356The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13357socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13358file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013360Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13361loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13362
13363 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13364
13365In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13366the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13367case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13368as well.
13369
13370The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13371sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13372do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13373methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13374is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013375obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013376followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13377default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13378that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13379string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13380
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013381The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13382By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13383string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13384resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13385server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013386waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013387flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13388function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013390There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13391sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13392be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013393
13394 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13395 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013396 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13397 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13398 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13399 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013400
13401 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13402 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013403 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013404
13405 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013406 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013407
13408 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013409 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013410
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013411 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013412 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13413
13414 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13415 binary or string samples.
13416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013417 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13418 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13421 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13422 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013424 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13425 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013427 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13428 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013430 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13431 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013433 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13434 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013435 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013437 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13438 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13439 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013440
13441For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13442request, it is possible to do :
13443
13444 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13445
13446In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13447buffer, one would use the following acl :
13448
13449 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13450
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013451On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13452possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13453
13454 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013456All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13457criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13458method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13459to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13460criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13461the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013463If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013464the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13465For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13468 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13469 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13470 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013471
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013472
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013473The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13474types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13475combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13476brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13477default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013479 +-------------------------------------------------+
13480 | Input sample type |
13481 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013482 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013483 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13484 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13485 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013486 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013487 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013488 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013489 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013490 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013491 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013492 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013493 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013494 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013495 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013496 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013497 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013498 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013499 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013500 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013501 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013502 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013503 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013504 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013505 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013506 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013507 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13508 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13509 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013510
13511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135127.1.1. Matching booleans
13513------------------------
13514
13515In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13516Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13517When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13518that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13519
13520Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13521return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13522"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13523
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135257.1.2. Matching integers
13526------------------------
13527
13528Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13529enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13530to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13531
13532Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13533matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13534lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013535
13536For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13537unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13538representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13539
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013540As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13541two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13542instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13543ranges and operators.
13544
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013545For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013546operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13547Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13548of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013549
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013550Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013551
13552 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13553 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13554 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13555 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13556 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13557
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013558For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013559
13560 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13561
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013562This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13563
13564 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13565
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200135677.1.3. Matching strings
13568-----------------------
13569
13570String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13571different forms :
13572
13573 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013574 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013575
13576 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013577 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013578
13579 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13580 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13581
13582 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13583 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13584
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013585 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013586 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13587 matches.
13588
13589 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13590 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13591 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013592
13593String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13594exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13595characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13596string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13597to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013598before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013599
Mathias Weiersmuellerb2fe2232019-12-02 09:43:40 +010013600Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
13601(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
13602Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
13603
13604Example:
13605 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
13606 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
13607
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136097.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13610---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013611
13612Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13613they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13614possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13615passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13616the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013617the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13618match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013619
13620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200136217.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13622-------------------------------------
13623
13624It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13625not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13626a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13627to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13628digits may be used upper or lower case.
13629
13630Example :
13631 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13632 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13633
13634
136357.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13636---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013637
13638IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13639netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13640within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013641host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013642difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13643at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13644does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13645parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013646
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013647The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13648abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13649
13650 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13651 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13652 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13653 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13654 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13655 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13656 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13657 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13658
13659Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13660192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13661
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013662IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13663Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13664trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13665IPv6 patterns.
13666
13667HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13668following situations :
13669 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13670 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13671 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13672 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13673 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13674 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13675 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13676 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13677 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13678 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013680
136817.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13682----------------------------------
13683
13684Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13685combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13686
13687 - AND (implicit)
13688 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13689 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013691A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013693 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013695Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13696indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013698For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13699"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13700requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13701is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13702
13703 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013704 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13705 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13706 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013707
13708To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13709and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13710
13711 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13712 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13713 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13714 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13715
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013716 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013717 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13718 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13719 use_backend www if host_www
13720
13721It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13722expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13723be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13724the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13725
13726 The following rule :
13727
13728 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013729 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013730
13731 Can also be written that way :
13732
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013733 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013734
13735It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13736to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13737simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13738sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13739good use is the following :
13740
13741 With named ACLs :
13742
13743 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13744 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13745 monitor fail if site_dead
13746
13747 With anonymous ACLs :
13748
13749 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13750
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013751See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13752keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013753
13754
137557.3. Fetching samples
13756---------------------
13757
13758Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13759against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13760sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13761ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13762of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13763available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13764
13765This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13766Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13767compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13768deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13769
13770The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13771matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13772method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13773indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13774
13775As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13776when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13777mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13778the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13779ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13780
13781Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13782multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13783when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013784incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13785are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013786is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13787all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13788
13789Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13790 - name
13791 - name(arg1)
13792 - name(arg1,arg2)
13793
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013794
137957.3.1. Converters
13796-----------------
13797
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013798Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13799of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13800is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13801was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013802has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013803unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13804
13805These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13806sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13807the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013808support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013809
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013810A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13811support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13812supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13813(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13814bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013816The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013817
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001381851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13819 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13820 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13821 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13822 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13823 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13824
13825 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013826 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13827 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013828 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13829 frontend http-in
13830 bind *:8081
13831 default_backend servers
13832 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13833 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13834
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013835add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013836 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013837 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013838 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13839 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013840 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013841 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13842 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13843 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13844 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013845 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013846 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013847
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013848aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13849 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13850 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13851 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13852 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13853 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13854 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13855
13856 Example:
13857 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13858 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13859
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013860and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013861 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013862 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013863 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13864 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013865 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013866 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13867 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13868 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13869 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013870 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013871 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013872
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013873b64dec
13874 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13875 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13876
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013877base64
13878 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013879 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013880 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13881
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013882bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013883 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013884 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013885 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013886 presence of a flag).
13887
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013888bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13889 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13890 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013891 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013892
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013893concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13894 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13895 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13896 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13897 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13898 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13899 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13900 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13901 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13902 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13903 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013904 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013905 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013906 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013907
13908 Example:
13909 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13910 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13911 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13912 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13913
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013914cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013915 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13916 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013917
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013918crc32([<avalanche>])
13919 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13920 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13921 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13922 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13923 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13924 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13925 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13926 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13927 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13928 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013929 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13930
13931crc32c([<avalanche>])
13932 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13933 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13934 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13935 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13936 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13937 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13938 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13939 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013940
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013941da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013942 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13943 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13944 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13945 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013946 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013947 configuration language.
13948
13949 Example:
13950 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013951 bind *:8881
13952 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013953 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013954
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013955debug
13956 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13957 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13958 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13959
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013960div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013961 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13962 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013963 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013964 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13965 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013966 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013967 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13968 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13969 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13970 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013971 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013972 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013973
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013974djb2([<avalanche>])
13975 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13976 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13977 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13978 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13979 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13980 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13981 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013982 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13983 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013984
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013985even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013986 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013987 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13988
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013989field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13990 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13991 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13992 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13993 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13994 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13995 fields.
13996
13997 Example :
13998 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13999 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14000 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14001 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14002 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014003
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014004hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014005 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014006 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014007 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014008 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014009
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014010hex2i
14011 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014012 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014013
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014014http_date([<offset>])
14015 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14016 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
14017 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
14018 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
14019 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
14020 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014021
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014022in_table(<table>)
14023 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14024 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14025 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014026 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014027 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14028
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014029ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14030 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014031 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014032 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14033 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14034 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14035 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14036 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014037
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014038json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014039 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014040 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014041 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014042 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14043 of errors:
14044 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14045 bytes, ...)
14046 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14047 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14048
14049 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14050 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14051 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14052 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14053 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14054 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014055 - "ascii" : never fails;
14056 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14057 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014058 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014059 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014060 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14061 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14062
14063 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014064 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014065
14066 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014067 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014068 capture request header user-agent len 150
14069 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014070
14071 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14072 GET / HTTP/1.0
14073 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14074
14075 Output log:
14076 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14077
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014078language(<value>[,<default>])
14079 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14080 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14081 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14082 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14083 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14084 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14085 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14086 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14087 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014088 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014089 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14090 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014091
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014092 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014093
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014094 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14095 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014096
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014097 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14098 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14099 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14100 use_backend spanish if es
14101 use_backend french if fr
14102 use_backend english if en
14103 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014104
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014105length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014106 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14107 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14108 type. The result is of type integer.
14109
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014110lower
14111 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14112 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14113 type. The result is of type string.
14114
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014115ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14116 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14117 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14118 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14119 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14120 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14121 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14122
14123 Example :
14124
14125 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014126 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014127 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14128
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014129map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14130map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14131map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14132 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14133 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14134 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14135 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14136 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14137 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14138 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14139 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014140
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014141 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14142 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14143 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014144
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014145 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014146 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014147
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014148 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14149 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14150 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14151 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014152 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14153 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014154 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14155 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14156 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14157 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14158 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14159 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14160 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14161 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014162 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14163 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14164 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014165 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14166 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14167 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14168 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14169 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014170
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014171 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14172 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14173 the corresponding match text.
14174
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014175 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14176 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14177 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14178 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14179 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014180
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014181 Example :
14182
14183 # this is a comment and is ignored
14184 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
14185 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
14186 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
14187 | | | `---------- value
14188 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
14189 | `---------------------------- key
14190 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
14191
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014192mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014193 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14194 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014195 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014196 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014197 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014198 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14199 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14200 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14201 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014202 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014203 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014204
14205mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014206 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020014207 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
14208 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014209 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014210 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014211 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014212 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14213 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14214 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14215 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014216 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014217 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014218
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010014219nbsrv
14220 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
14221 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
14222 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
14223 map lookup.
14224
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014225neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014226 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14227 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14228 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14229 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014230
14231not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014232 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014233 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014234 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014235 absence of a flag).
14236
14237odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014238 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014239 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14240
14241or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014242 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014243 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014244 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14245 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014246 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014247 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14248 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14249 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14250 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014251 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014252 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014253
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014254protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14255 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14256 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14257 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14258 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14259 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14260 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14261 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14262 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14263 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14264 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14265 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14266
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014267regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014268 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14269 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14270 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14271 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14272 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14273 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14274 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14275 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14276 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14277 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014278 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14279 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14280 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14281 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014282
14283 Example :
14284
14285 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14286 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14287 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14288 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14289
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014290capture-req(<id>)
14291 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14292 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14293
14294 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014295 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14296 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014297
14298capture-res(<id>)
14299 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14300 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14301
14302 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014303 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14304 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014305
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014306sdbm([<avalanche>])
14307 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14308 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14309 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14310 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14311 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14312 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14313 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014314 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14315 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014316
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014317set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014318 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14319 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14320 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014321 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014322 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14323 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014324 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014325 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14326 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014327 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014328 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014329
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014330sha1
14331 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14332 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14333
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014334strcmp(<var>)
14335 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14336 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14337 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14338 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14339 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14340 shorter).
14341
14342 Example :
14343
14344 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14345 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14346 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14347
14348
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014349sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014350 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14351 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014352 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014353 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14354 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014355 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014356 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14357 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014358 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014359 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14360 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014361 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014362 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014363
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014364table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14365 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14366 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14367 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14368 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14369 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14370 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14371
14372
14373table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14374 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14375 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14376 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14377 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14378 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14379 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14380
14381table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14382 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14383 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014384 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014385 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14386 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14387
14388table_conn_cur(<table>)
14389 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14390 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14391 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14392 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14393 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14394
14395table_conn_rate(<table>)
14396 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14397 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14398 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14399 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14400 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14401
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014402table_gpt0(<table>)
14403 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14404 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14405 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14406 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14407 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14408
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014409table_gpc0(<table>)
14410 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14411 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14412 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14413 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14414 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14415
14416table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14417 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14418 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14419 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14420 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14421 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14422 sample fetch keyword.
14423
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014424table_gpc1(<table>)
14425 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14426 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14427 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14428 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14429 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14430
14431table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14432 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14433 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14434 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14435 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14436 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14437 sample fetch keyword.
14438
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014439table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14440 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14441 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014442 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014443 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14444 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14445
14446table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14447 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14448 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14449 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14450 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14451 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14452 keyword.
14453
14454table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14455 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14456 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014457 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014458 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14459 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14460
14461table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14462 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14463 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14464 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14465 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14466 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14467 keyword.
14468
14469table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14470 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14471 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014472 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014473 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14474 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14475 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14476 keyword.
14477
14478table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14479 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14480 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014481 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014482 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14483 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14484 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14485 keyword.
14486
14487table_server_id(<table>)
14488 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14489 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14490 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14491 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14492 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14493 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14494
14495table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14496 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14497 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014498 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014499 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14500 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14501 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14502 keyword.
14503
14504table_sess_rate(<table>)
14505 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14506 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14507 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14508 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14509 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14510 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14511 keyword.
14512
14513table_trackers(<table>)
14514 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14515 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14516 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14517 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14518 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14519 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14520 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14521 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14522 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14523 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14524
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014525upper
14526 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14527 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14528 type. The result is of type string.
14529
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014530url_dec
14531 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14532 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14533
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014534ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014535 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014536 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14537 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14538 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014539 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14540 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14541 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14542 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014543 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014544 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14545 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014546
14547 Example:
14548 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14549 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14550
14551 message Point {
14552 int32 latitude = 1;
14553 int32 longitude = 2;
14554 }
14555
14556 message PPoint {
14557 Point point = 59;
14558 }
14559
14560 message Rectangle {
14561 // One corner of the rectangle.
14562 PPoint lo = 48;
14563 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14564 PPoint hi = 49;
14565 }
14566
14567 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14568 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14569 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14570
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014571 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14572 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014573 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014574 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14575
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014576 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014577
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014578 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014579
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014580 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014581 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14582 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14583
14584 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14585 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14586 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14587
14588 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14589 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14590 interpret the previous binary sample.
14591
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014592
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014593unset-var(<var name>)
14594 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14595 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14596 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14597 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14598 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14599 response),
14600 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14601 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14602 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14603 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14604
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014605utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14606 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14607 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14608 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14609 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14610 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14611 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14612
14613 Example :
14614
14615 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014616 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014617 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14618
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014619word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14620 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14621 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14622 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014623 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014624 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14625 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14626
14627 Example :
14628 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14629 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14630 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14631 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14632 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnind1fa5fa2020-01-28 13:33:44 +010014633 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014634
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014635wt6([<avalanche>])
14636 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14637 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14638 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14639 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14640 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14641 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14642 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014643 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14644 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014645
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014646xor(<value>)
14647 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014648 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014649 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014650 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014651 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014652 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14653 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014654 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014655 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14656 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014657 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014658 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014659
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014660xxh32([<seed>])
14661 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14662 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14663 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14664 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14665 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14666 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14667 as cryptographically secure.
14668
14669xxh64([<seed>])
14670 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14671 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14672 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14673 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14674 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14675 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14676 as cryptographically secure.
14677
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014678
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014680--------------------------------------------
14681
14682A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14683not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14684"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14685The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14686
14687always_false : boolean
14688 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14689 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14690
14691always_true : boolean
14692 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14693 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14694
14695avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014696 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014697 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14698 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14699 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14700 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14701 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14702 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14703 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14704 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14705 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14706 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14707 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14708 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14709 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014711be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014712 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14713 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14714 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14715 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014716 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14717
14718be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14719 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14720 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14721 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14722 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14723 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014724 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14725 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014726
14727 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14728 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14729 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014731be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14732 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14733 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14734 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014735 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014736 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14737 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014738
14739 Example :
14740 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14741 backend dynamic
14742 mode http
14743 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14744 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014745
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014746bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014747 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14748 of the string.
14749
14750bool(<bool>) : bool
14751 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14752 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014754connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14755 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014756 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014757 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14758 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014759
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014760 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014761 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014762 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14763
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014764 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14765 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014766
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014767 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014768 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014769 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014770 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014771 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014772 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014773 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014774
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014775 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14776 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014777 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014778 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014779
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014780cpu_calls : integer
14781 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14782 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14783 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14784 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14785 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14786 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14787
14788cpu_ns_avg : integer
14789 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14790 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14791 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14792 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14793 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14794 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14795 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14796 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14797 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14798 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14799 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14800
14801cpu_ns_tot : integer
14802 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14803 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14804 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14805 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14806 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14807 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14808 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14809 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14810 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14811 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14812 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14813 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14814 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14815
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014816date([<offset>]) : integer
14817 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14818 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14819 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14820 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014821 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14822
14823 Example :
14824
14825 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14826 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014827
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014828date_us : integer
14829 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14830 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14831 from the same timeval structure.
14832
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014833distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14834 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14835 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14836 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14837 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14838 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14839 list of supported tokens.
14840
14841distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14842 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14843 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14844 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14845 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14846 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14847 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14848 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14849 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14850 supported tokens.
14851
14852 Example :
14853 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14854 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14855 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14856 # send large files to the big farm
14857 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14858
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014859env(<name>) : string
14860 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14861 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14862 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14863 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14864 certain way.
14865
14866 Examples :
14867 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14868 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14869
14870 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14871 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014873fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14874 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014875 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14876 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14878 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014879 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014880 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14881 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014882
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014883fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14884 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14885 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14886 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14889 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14890 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14891 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14892 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14893 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14894 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14895 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14896 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014897
14898 Example :
14899 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14900 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14901 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14902 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14903 frontend mail
14904 bind :25
14905 mode tcp
14906 maxconn 100
14907 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14908 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14909 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14910 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014911
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014912hostname : string
14913 Returns the system hostname.
14914
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014915int(<integer>) : signed integer
14916 Returns a signed integer.
14917
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014918ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14919 Returns an ipv4.
14920
14921ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14922 Returns an ipv6.
14923
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014924lat_ns_avg : integer
14925 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14926 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14927 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14928 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14929 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14930 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14931 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14932 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14933 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14934 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14935 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14936 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14937 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14938 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14939
14940lat_ns_tot : integer
14941 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14942 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14943 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14944 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14945 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14946 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14947 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14948 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14949 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14950 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14951 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14952 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14953 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14954 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14955 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14956 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14957 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14958 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14959 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14960
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014961meth(<method>) : method
14962 Returns a method.
14963
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014964nbproc : integer
14965 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14966 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14967 and debugging purposes.
14968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14970 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14971 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14972 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014973 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14974 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14975 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014976
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014977prio_class : integer
14978 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14979 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14980 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14981
14982prio_offset : integer
14983 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14984 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14985 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14986 set-priority-offset".
14987
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014988proc : integer
14989 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14990 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14991 debugging purposes.
14992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014994 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14995 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14996 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014997 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14998 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14999 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15000 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15001 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15002
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015003rand([<range>]) : integer
15004 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15005 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15006 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15007 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15008 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15009
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015010uuid([<version>]) : string
15011 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15012 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15013 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015015srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15016 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15017 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15018 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15019 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15020 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015021 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15022 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15023
15024srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15025 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15026 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15027 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15028 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15029 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15030 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15031 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15032
15033 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15034 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015035
15036srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15037 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15038 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15039 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015040 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015041 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15042 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15043 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15044
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015045srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15046 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15047 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15048 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15049 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15050 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15051 fetch methods.
15052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015053srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15054 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15055 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015056 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015057 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15058 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015059 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015060 overloading servers).
15061
15062 Example :
15063 # Redirect to a separate back
15064 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15065 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15066 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15067
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015068stopping : boolean
15069 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15070 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15071 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15072
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015073str(<string>) : string
15074 Returns a string.
15075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15077 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15078 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15079
15080table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15081 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15082 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15083 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15084
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015085thread : integer
15086 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15087 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15088 and debugging purposes.
15089
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015090var(<var-name>) : undefined
15091 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015092 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15093 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015094 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015095 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15096 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015097 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015098 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15099 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015100 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015101 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015102
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200151037.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104----------------------------------
15105
15106The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15107closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15108methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15109sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15110TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015111the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15112counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020015113"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
15114used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
15115can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
15116Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
15117table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
15118tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
15119currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015120
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010015121bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010015122 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15123 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15124 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
15125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015126be_id : integer
15127 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
15128 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15129
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015130be_name : string
15131 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
15132 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
15133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015134dst : ip
15135 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
15136 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
15137 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
15138 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015139 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
15140 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
15141 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
15142 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
15143 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
15144 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015145
15146dst_conn : integer
15147 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15148 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
15149 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
15150 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
15151 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
15152 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
15153 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
15154 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015155
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015156dst_is_local : boolean
15157 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
15158 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
15159 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
15160 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015161 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015162 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
15163 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
15164 it only once per connection.
15165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015166dst_port : integer
15167 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
15168 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
15169 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
15170 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
15171 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
15172 an HTTP header.
15173
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020015174fc_http_major : integer
15175 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
15176 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
15177 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
15178
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010015179fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
15180 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
15181 header.
15182
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020015183fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
15184 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
15185 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
15186 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
15187 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15188 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15189 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15190
15191fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
15192 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
15193 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
15194 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
15195 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
15196 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
15197 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15198
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015199fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015200 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15201 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15202 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15203 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15204
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015205fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015206 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
15207 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
15208 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
15209 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15210
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015211fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015212 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
15213 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15214 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15215 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15216
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015217fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015218 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
15219 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15220 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15221 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15222
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015223fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015224 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
15225 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15226 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15227 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15228
Christopher Faulet297df182019-10-17 14:40:48 +020015229fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070015230 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15231 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15232 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15233 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15234
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015235fe_defbe : string
15236 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15237 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015239fe_id : integer
15240 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015241 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015242 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15243
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015244fe_name : string
15245 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15246 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15247 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15248
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015249sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015250sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15251sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15252sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015253 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15254 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15255 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15256
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015257sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015258sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15259sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15260sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015261 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15262 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15263 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15264
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015265sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015266sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15267sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15268sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015269 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15270 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015271 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15272 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15273 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015274
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015275 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015276 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15277 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015278 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15279 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15280 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015281 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15282 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15283
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015284sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15285sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15286sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15287sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15288 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15289 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15290 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15291 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15292 when a first ACL was verified.
15293
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015294sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015295sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15296sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15297sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015298 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015299 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15300
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015301sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015302sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15303sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15304sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015305 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15306 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15307 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15308
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015309sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015310sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15311sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15312sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015313 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15314 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15315 See also src_conn_rate.
15316
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015317sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015318sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15319sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15320sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015321 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015322 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015323
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015324sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15325sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15326sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15327sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15328 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15329 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15330
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015331sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15332sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15333sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15334sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15335 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15336 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15337
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015338sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015339sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15340sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15341sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015342 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15343 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15344 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015345 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15346 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15347 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015348
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015349sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15350sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15351sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15352sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15353 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15354 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15355 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15356 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15357 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15358 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15359
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015360sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015361sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15362sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15363sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015364 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015365 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15366 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15367
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015368sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015369sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15370sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15371sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015372 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15373 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15374 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15375 src_http_err_rate.
15376
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015377sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015378sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15379sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15380sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015381 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015382 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15383 src_http_req_cnt.
15384
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015385sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015386sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15387sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15388sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015389 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15390 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15391 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15392 src_http_req_rate.
15393
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015394sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015395sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15396sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15397sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015398 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015399 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15400 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15401 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15402 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015403
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015404 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015405 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15406 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015407 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15408
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015409sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15410sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15411sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15412sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15413 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15414 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15415 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15416 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15417 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15418
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015419sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015420sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15421sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15422sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015423 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15424 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15425 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015426
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015427sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015428sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15429sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15430sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015431 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15432 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15433 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015434
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015435sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015436sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15437sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15438sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015439 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015440 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15441 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15442 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015443 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015444 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15445
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015446sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015447sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15448sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15449sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015450 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15451 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15452 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15453 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15454 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015455 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015456
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015457sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015458sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15459sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15460sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015461 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15462 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15463 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15464
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015465sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015466sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15467sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15468sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015469 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15470 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015471 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015472 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15473 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015474 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15475 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15476 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015478so_id : integer
15479 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15480 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15481 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015482
Jerome Magnin28b90332020-03-27 22:08:40 +010015483so_name : string
15484 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
15485 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
15486 strings instead of integers.
15487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015489 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15491 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15492 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015493 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15494 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15495 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015496 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15497 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15498 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15499 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15500 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15501 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15502 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015503
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015504 Example:
15505 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15506 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15509 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15510 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15511 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015512 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015514src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15515 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15516 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015517 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015518 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15521 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15522 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15523 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15524 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15525 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15526 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015527
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015528 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015529 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15530 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15531 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15532 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015533 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015534 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15535 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15536
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015537src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15538 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15539 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15540 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15541 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15542 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15543 was verified.
15544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015546 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015548 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015549 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015552 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15554 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015555 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15558 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15559 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15560 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015561 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015564 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015565 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015566 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015567 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015568
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015569src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15570 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15571 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15572 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15573 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15574
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015575src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15576 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15577 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15578 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15579 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015581src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015582 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015583 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015584 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15585 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015586 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15587 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15588 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015589
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015590src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15591 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15592 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15593 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15594 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15595 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15596 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15597 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015600 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015602 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015603 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015606src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15607 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15608 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15609 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15610 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015611 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015613src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015614 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015615 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15616 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015617 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15620 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15621 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15622 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015623 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015624 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15627 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15628 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15629 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015630 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015631 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15632 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015633
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015634 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015635 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015636 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015637 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015638
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015639src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15640 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15641 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15642 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15643 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15644 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15645 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15646
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015647src_is_local : boolean
15648 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15649 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15650 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15651 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015652 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015653 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15654 once per connection.
15655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015656src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015657 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15658 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15659 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15660 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15661 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015663src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015664 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15665 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15666 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15667 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15668 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015670src_port : integer
15671 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15672 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15673 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15674 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015676src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015677 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015678 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15679 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15680 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015681 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15684 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15685 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15686 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15687 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015688 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015690src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15691 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15692 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15693 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15694 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15695 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15696 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15697 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15698 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015699
15700 Example :
15701 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15702 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15703 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15704 listen ssh
15705 bind :22
15706 mode tcp
15707 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015708 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015709 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015710 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015712srv_id : integer
15713 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15714 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15715 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015716
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157177.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15721closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15722when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15723usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015724future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015725
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001572651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15727 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15728 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15729 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15730 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15731 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15732
15733 Example :
15734 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15735 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15736 # the request.
15737 frontend http-in
15738 bind *:8081
15739 default_backend servers
15740 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15741 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15742
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015743ssl_bc : boolean
15744 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15745 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15746 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15747
15748ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15749 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15750 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15751
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015752ssl_bc_alpn : string
15753 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15754 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015755 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015756 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15757 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15758 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15759 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15760 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15761 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15762
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015763ssl_bc_cipher : string
15764 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15765 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15766
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015767ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15768 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15769 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15770 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15771
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015772ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15773 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15774 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15775 session or a TLS ticket.
15776
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015777ssl_bc_npn : string
15778 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15779 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015780 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015781 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15782 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15783 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15784 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15785 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15786
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015787ssl_bc_protocol : string
15788 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15789 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15790
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015791ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015792 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015793 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15794 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015795
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015796ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15797 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15798 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15799 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15800
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015801ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15802 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15803 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15804 if session was reused or not.
15805
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015806ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15807 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15808 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15809 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15810 BoringSSL.
15811
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015812ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15813 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15814 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015816ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15817 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15818 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15819 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15820 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15821 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015823ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15824 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15825 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15826 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15827 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015828
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015829ssl_c_der : binary
15830 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15831 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15832 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015834ssl_c_err : integer
15835 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15836 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15837 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15838 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15839 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015841ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15842 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15843 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15844 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15845 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15846 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15847 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15848 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15849 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015851ssl_c_key_alg : string
15852 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15853 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15854 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015856ssl_c_notafter : string
15857 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15858 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15859 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015861ssl_c_notbefore : string
15862 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15863 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15864 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015866ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15867 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15868 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15869 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15870 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15871 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15872 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15873 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15874 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015876ssl_c_serial : binary
15877 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15878 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15879 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015881ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15882 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15883 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15884 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015885 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15886 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15887
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015888 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015889 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15892 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15893 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15894 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015896ssl_c_used : boolean
15897 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15898 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900ssl_c_verify : integer
15901 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15902 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15903 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15904 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906ssl_c_version : integer
15907 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15908 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015909
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015910ssl_f_der : binary
15911 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15912 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15913 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015915ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15916 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15917 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15918 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15919 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015920 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15922 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15923 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015925ssl_f_key_alg : string
15926 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15927 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15928 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015930ssl_f_notafter : string
15931 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15932 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15933 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015935ssl_f_notbefore : string
15936 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15937 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15938 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15941 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15942 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15943 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15944 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15945 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15946 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15947 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15948 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015950ssl_f_serial : binary
15951 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15952 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15953 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015954
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015955ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15956 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15957 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15958 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015960ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15961 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15962 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15963 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965ssl_f_version : integer
15966 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15967 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15968
15969ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015970 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15971 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15972 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015974 Example :
15975 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15976 listen http-https
15977 bind :80
15978 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15979 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15980
15981ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15982 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15983 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15984
15985ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015986 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015987 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15988 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15989 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15990 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15991 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15992 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15993 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15994 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015996ssl_fc_cipher : string
15997 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15998 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015999
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016000ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16001 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16002 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016003 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016004
16005ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16006 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16007 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016008 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016009
16010ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16011 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16012 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16013 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016014 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016015 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016016
16017ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16018 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16019 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016020 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016021
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016022ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16023 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16024 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16025 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016028 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16029 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016030 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16031 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16032 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16033 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016034
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016035ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16036 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16037 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16038 wait until the handshake happened.
16039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016040ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16041 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016042 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16043 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016044 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016045 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016046
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016047ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016048 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016049 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16050 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016052ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016053 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016054 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16055 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16056 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16057 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16058 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16059 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16060 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016062ssl_fc_protocol : string
16063 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16064 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016065
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016066ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016067 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016068 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
16069 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040016070
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016071ssl_fc_server_random : binary
16072 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16073 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16074 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016076ssl_fc_session_id : binary
16077 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
16078 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
16079 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
16080 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016081
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016082ssl_fc_session_key : binary
16083 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
16084 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16085 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
16086 BoringSSL.
16087
16088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016089ssl_fc_sni : string
16090 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
16091 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
16092 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
16093 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
16094 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
16095
16096 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
16097 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
16098 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016099 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020016100 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016102 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016103 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
16104 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020016105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016106ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
16107 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
16108 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016109
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016110
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161117.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016112------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020016113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016114Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
16115sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
16116only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
16117For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
16118be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
16119can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
16120sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
16121for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
16122content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016124payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016125 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016126 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
16127 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016129payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
16130 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016131 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016132 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016133
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020016134req.hdrs : string
16135 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
16136 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
16137 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
16138 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
16139
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020016140req.hdrs_bin : binary
16141 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
16142 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
16143 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
16144 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
16145 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
16146 names and values (length of 0 for both).
16147
16148 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
16149
16150 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
16151 str: <int:length><bytes>
16152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016153req.len : integer
16154req_len : integer (deprecated)
16155 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16156 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16157 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16158 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16159 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16160 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16161 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
16162 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016164req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16165 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016166 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16167 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16168 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16169 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016171 ACL alternatives :
16172 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016174req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16175 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16176 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16177 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
16178 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016180 ACL alternatives :
16181 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016185req.proto_http : boolean
16186req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
16187 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
16188 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
16189 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
16190 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
16191 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
16192 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
16193 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016195 Example:
16196 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
16197 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16198 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016199 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020016200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016201req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
16202rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16203 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
16204 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
16205 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
16206 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
16207 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
16208 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
16209 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016211 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
16212 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
16213 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
16214 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
16215 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
16216 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016218 ACL derivatives :
16219 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016221 Example :
16222 listen tse-farm
16223 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
16224 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
16225 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16226 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
16227 # apply RDP cookie persistence
16228 persist rdp-cookie
16229 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
16230 # This is only useful makes sense if
16231 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16232 stick-table type string size 204800
16233 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16234 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16235 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16238 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016240req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16241rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16242 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16243 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16244 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16245 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016247 ACL derivatives :
16248 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016249
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016250req.ssl_alpn : string
16251 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16252 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16253 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16254 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16255 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16256 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016257 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016258
16259 Examples :
16260 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16261 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16262 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016263 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016264 default_backend bk_default
16265
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016266req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16267 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16268 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016269 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16270 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16271 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16272 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16273 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016275req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16276req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16277 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16278 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16279 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16280 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16281 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16282 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16283 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016285req.ssl_sni : string
16286req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16287 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16288 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16289 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16290 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16291 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16292 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16293 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16294 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16295 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16296 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16297 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16298 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016300 ACL derivatives :
16301 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016303 Examples :
16304 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16305 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16306 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16307 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16308 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016309
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016310req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16311 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16312 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16313 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16314 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16315 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16316 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16317 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16318 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16319 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016321req.ssl_ver : integer
16322req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16323 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16324 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16325 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16326 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16327 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16328 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16329 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016330 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016331 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016333 ACL derivatives :
16334 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016335
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016336res.len : integer
16337 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16338 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16339 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16340 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16341 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16342 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16343 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16344 content inspection.
16345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016346res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16347 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016348 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16349 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16350 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16351 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016353res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16354 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16355 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16356 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16357 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016359 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016360
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016361res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16362rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16363 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16364 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16365 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16366 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16367 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16368 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16369 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016371wait_end : boolean
16372 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16373 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016374 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016375 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16376 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016377 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016378 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16379 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016381 Examples :
16382 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16383 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16384 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016386 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16387 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16388 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16389 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16390 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16391 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16392 tcp-request content reject
16393
16394
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200163957.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016396--------------------------------------
16397
16398It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16399This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16400data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16401its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16402HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16403content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16404to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16405more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16406response are indexed.
16407
16408base : string
16409 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16410 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16411 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16412 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16413 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16414 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16415 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16416 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16417
16418 ACL derivatives :
16419 base : exact string match
16420 base_beg : prefix match
16421 base_dir : subdir match
16422 base_dom : domain match
16423 base_end : suffix match
16424 base_len : length match
16425 base_reg : regex match
16426 base_sub : substring match
16427
16428base32 : integer
16429 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16430 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16431 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016432 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16433 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16434 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016435
16436base32+src : binary
16437 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16438 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16439 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16440 per-URL counters.
16441
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016442capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16443 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16444 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16445 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16446
16447capture.req.method : string
16448 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16449 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16450 because it's allocated.
16451
16452capture.req.uri : string
16453 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16454 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16455 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16456 allocated.
16457
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016458capture.req.ver : string
16459 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16460 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16461 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16462
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016463capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16464 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16465 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16466 The first entry is an index of 0.
16467 See also: "capture response header"
16468
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016469capture.res.ver : string
16470 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16471 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16472 persistent flag.
16473
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016474req.body : binary
16475 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16476 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16477 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16478 the first chunk is analyzed.
16479
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016480req.body_param([<name>) : string
16481 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16482 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16483 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16484 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16485 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16486 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16487 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16488 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16489 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16490 given.
16491
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016492req.body_len : integer
16493 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16494 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16495 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16496 "option http-buffer-request".
16497
16498req.body_size : integer
16499 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16500 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16501 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16502 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16503 "option http-buffer-request".
16504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016505req.cook([<name>]) : string
16506cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16507 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16508 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16509 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16510 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16511 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16512 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16513 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16514 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16515
16516 ACL derivatives :
16517 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16518 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16519 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16520 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16521 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16522 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16523 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16524 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016526req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16527cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16528 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16529 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016531req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16532cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16533 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16534 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16535 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16536 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016538cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16539 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16540 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16541 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16542 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016543 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016544 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16545 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16546 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16547 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016549hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16550 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16551 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16552 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16553 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016554 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016556req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16557 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16558 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16559 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16560 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16561 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16562 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16563 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16564 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016566req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16567 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16568 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16569 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16570 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016572req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16573 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16574 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16575 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16576 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16577 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16578 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16579 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16580 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016581 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016582 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016583 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016585 ACL derivatives :
16586 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16587 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16588 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16589 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16590 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16591 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16592 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16593 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16594
16595req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16596hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16597 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16598 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16599 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16600 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16601 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16602 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16603 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16604 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16605 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16606
16607req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16608hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16609 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16610 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16611 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16612 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16613 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016614 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016615 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16616 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16617
16618req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16619hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16620 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16621 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16622 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16623 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16624 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16625 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16626 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16627
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016628
16629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016630http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16631 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16632 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16633 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16634 basic auth is supported.
16635
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016636http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16637 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16638 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16639 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16640 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016641 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16642 basic auth is supported.
16643
16644 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016645 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16646 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16647 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16648 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016649
16650http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016651 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16652 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016653 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16654 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016656method : integer + string
16657 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16658 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16659 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16660 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16661 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16662 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16663 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016665 ACL derivatives :
16666 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016668 Example :
16669 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16670 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16671 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016673path : string
16674 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16675 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16676 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16677 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16678 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016679 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016680 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016682 ACL derivatives :
16683 path : exact string match
16684 path_beg : prefix match
16685 path_dir : subdir match
16686 path_dom : domain match
16687 path_end : suffix match
16688 path_len : length match
16689 path_reg : regex match
16690 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016691
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016692query : string
16693 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16694 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16695 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16696 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016697 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016698 which stops before the question mark.
16699
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016700req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16701 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16702 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16703 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16704 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016706req.ver : string
16707req_ver : string (deprecated)
16708 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16709 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16710 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016712 ACL derivatives :
16713 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016715res.comp : boolean
16716 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16717 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16718 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016720res.comp_algo : string
16721 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16722 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16723 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016725res.cook([<name>]) : string
16726scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16727 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16728 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16729 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016731 ACL derivatives :
16732 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016734res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16735scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16736 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16737 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16738 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016740res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16741scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16742 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16743 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16744 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016746res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16747 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16748 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16749 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16750 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16751 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16752 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16753 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16754 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16755 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016757res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16758 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16759 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16760 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16761 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16762 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016764res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16765shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16766 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16767 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16768 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16769 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16770 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16771 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16772 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16773 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016775 ACL derivatives :
16776 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16777 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16778 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16779 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16780 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16781 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16782 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16783 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16784
16785res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16786shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16787 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16788 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16789 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16790 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16791 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016793res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16794shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16795 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16796 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16797 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16798 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16799 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16800 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016801
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016802res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16803 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16804 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16805 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16806 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016808res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16809shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16810 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16811 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16812 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16813 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16814 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16815 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016817res.ver : string
16818resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16819 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16820 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016822 ACL derivatives :
16823 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016825set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16826 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16827 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016828 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016829 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016831 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16832 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016834status : integer
16835 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16836 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16837 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016838
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016839unique-id : string
16840 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16841 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16842 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16843 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16844 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16845 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016847url : string
16848 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16849 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16850 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16851 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16852 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16853 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16854 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016856 ACL derivatives :
16857 url : exact string match
16858 url_beg : prefix match
16859 url_dir : subdir match
16860 url_dom : domain match
16861 url_end : suffix match
16862 url_len : length match
16863 url_reg : regex match
16864 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016866url_ip : ip
16867 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16868 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16869 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16870 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16871 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16872 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16873 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016875url_port : integer
16876 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16877 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16878 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16879 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016880
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016881urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16882url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016883 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16884 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016885 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16886 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16887 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16888 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16890 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016891 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16892 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016894 ACL derivatives :
16895 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16896 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16897 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16898 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16899 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16900 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16901 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16902 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016903
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016905 Example :
16906 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16907 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16908 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16909 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016910
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016911urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016912 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16913 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16914 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016915
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016916url32 : integer
16917 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16918 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16919 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16920 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16921 is an unsigned integer.
16922
16923url32+src : binary
16924 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16925 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16926 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16927
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169297.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016930---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016931
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016932Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16933every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016934order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016936ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16937---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016938FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016939HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016940HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16941HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016942HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16943HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16944HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16945HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16946LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016947METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016948METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016949METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16950METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16951METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16952METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016953METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016954METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016955RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016956REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016957TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016958WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16959---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016960
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169628. Logging
16963----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016964
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016965One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16966provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16967very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16968provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16969state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016970to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016971headers.
16972
16973In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16974about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16975send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16976
16977 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16978 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16979 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16980 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16981 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016982 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016983 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016984
16985The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16986allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16987as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16988while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16989real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16990delay.
16991
16992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169938.1. Log levels
16994---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016995
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016996TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016997source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016998HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16999in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
17000track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
17001syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
17002about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017003
17004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170058.2. Log formats
17006----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017007
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017008HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090017009and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
17010slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
17011options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017012
17013 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
17014 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
17015 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
17016 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
17017 extents.
17018
17019 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
17020 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
17021 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
17022 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
17023 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
17024
17025 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
17026 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
17027 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
17028 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
17029 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
17030
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020017031 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
17032 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
17033 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
17034 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
17035
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017036 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
17037
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017038Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
17039specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
17040field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
17041servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
17042always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
17043identifier.
17044
17045Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
17046 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
17047 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
17048 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
17049 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
17050
17051
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170528.2.1. Default log format
17053-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017054
17055This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
17056as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
17057format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
17058
17059 Example :
17060 listen www
17061 mode http
17062 log global
17063 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17064
17065 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
17066 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
17067 (www/HTTP)
17068
17069 Field Format Extract from the example above
17070 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
17071 2 'Connect from' Connect from
17072 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
17073 4 'to' to
17074 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
17075 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
17076
17077Detailed fields description :
17078 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
17079 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
17080 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
17081 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
17082 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17083 and processed the connection.
17084 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
17085
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017086In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
17087"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
17088connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
17089
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017090It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
17091will eventually disappear.
17092
17093
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170948.2.2. TCP log format
17095---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017096
17097The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
17098is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
17099information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
17100counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
17101emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
17102environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
17103the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
17104sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017105specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
17106not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
17107fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
17108marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017109
17110 Example :
17111 frontend fnt
17112 mode tcp
17113 option tcplog
17114 log global
17115 default_backend bck
17116
17117 backend bck
17118 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17119
17120 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
17121 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
17122 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
17123
17124 Field Format Extract from the example above
17125 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
17126 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
17127 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
17128 4 frontend_name fnt
17129 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
17130 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
17131 7 bytes_read* 212
17132 8 termination_state --
17133 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
17134 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17135
17136Detailed fields description :
17137 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017138 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17139 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17140 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017141 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017142 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017143 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017144
17145 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017146 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17147 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17148 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017149
17150 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
17151 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
17152 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017153 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
17154 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
17155 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
17156 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017157
17158 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17159 and processed the connection.
17160
17161 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17162 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17163 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
17164 applications.
17165
17166 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17167 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17168 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17169 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
17170 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
17171
17172 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17173 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
17174 See "Timers" below for more details.
17175
17176 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17177 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
17178 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
17179 "Timers" below for more details.
17180
17181 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017182 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017183 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
17184 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
17185 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
17186 details.
17187
17188 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
17189 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
17190 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
17191 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
17192 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
17193
17194 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17195 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17196 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
17197 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
17198 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
17199 for more details.
17200
17201 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017202 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017203 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
17204 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
17205 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017206 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017207
17208 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17209 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17210 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17211 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17212 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17213 caused by a denial of service attack.
17214
17215 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17216 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17217 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17218 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17219 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17220 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17221 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17222 denial of service attack.
17223
17224 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17225 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17226 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17227 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17228 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17229 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17230 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17231 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17232 be processed than on other servers.
17233
17234 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17235 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17236 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17237 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17238 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17239 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17240 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17241 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17242 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17243 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17244 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17245 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17246 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17247
17248 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17249 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17250 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17251 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17252 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17253 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017254 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017255 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17256
17257 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17258 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17259 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17260 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17261 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17262 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017263 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017264 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17265 occurs.
17266
17267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172688.2.3. HTTP log format
17269----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017270
17271The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17272is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17273the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17274are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17275emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17276generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17277"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17278which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017279frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17280is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017281
17282Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17283slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17284with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17285
17286 Example :
17287 frontend http-in
17288 mode http
17289 option httplog
17290 log global
17291 default_backend bck
17292
17293 backend static
17294 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17295
17296 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17297 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17298 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017299 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017300
17301 Field Format Extract from the example above
17302 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17303 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017304 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017305 4 frontend_name http-in
17306 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017307 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017308 7 status_code 200
17309 8 bytes_read* 2750
17310 9 captured_request_cookie -
17311 10 captured_response_cookie -
17312 11 termination_state ----
17313 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17314 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17315 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17316 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17317 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017318
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017319Detailed fields description :
17320 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017321 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17322 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17323 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017324 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017325 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017326 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017327
17328 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017329 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17330 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17331 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017332
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017333 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17334 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017335
17336 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17337 and processed the connection.
17338
17339 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17340 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17341 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17342
17343 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17344 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17345 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17346 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17347 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17348 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17349
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017350 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17351 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17352 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017353 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017354 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17355 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017356 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17357 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017358
17359 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17360 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017361 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017362
17363 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17364 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017365 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17366 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017367
17368 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17369 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17370 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17371 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17372 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017373 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17374 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017375
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017376 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17377 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17378 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17379 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17380 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17381 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17382 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017383 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017384
17385 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17386 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17387 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17388
17389 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17390 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017391 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017392 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17393 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17394 overflowing.
17395
17396 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17397 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17398 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17399 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17400 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17401 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17402 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17403 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17404
17405 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17406 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17407 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17408 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17409 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17410 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17411 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17412 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17413
17414 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17415 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17416 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17417 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17418 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17419 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17420 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17421
17422 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017423 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017424 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17425 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17426 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017427 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017428 system.
17429
17430 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17431 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17432 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17433 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17434 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17435 caused by a denial of service attack.
17436
17437 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17438 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17439 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17440 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17441 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17442 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17443 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17444 denial of service attack.
17445
17446 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17447 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17448 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17449 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17450 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17451 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17452 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17453 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17454 processed than on other servers.
17455
17456 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17457 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17458 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17459 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17460 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17461 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17462 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17463 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17464 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17465 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17466 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17467 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17468 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17469
17470 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17471 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17472 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17473 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17474 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17475 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017476 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017477 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17478
17479 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17480 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17481 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17482 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17483 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17484 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017485 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017486 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17487 occurs.
17488
17489 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17490 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17491 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17492 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17493 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17494 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17495 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17496 cookies" below for more details.
17497
17498 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17499 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17500 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17501 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17502 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17503 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17504 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17505 and cookies" below for more details.
17506
17507 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17508 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17509 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17510 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17511 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17512 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17513 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17514 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17515
17516
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200175178.2.4. Custom log format
17518------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017519
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017520The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017521mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017522
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017523HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017524Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17525separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17526prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17527
17528Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17529variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017530("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017531
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017532If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017533as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017534less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17535the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17536
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017537Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017538In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017539in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017540
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017541Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17542'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17543https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17544such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17545
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017546Flags are :
17547 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017548 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017549 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17550 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017551
17552 Example:
17553
17554 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17555 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17556
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017557 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17558
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017559At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17560
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017561 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17562 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017563
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017564the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017565
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017566 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17567 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17568 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017569
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017570and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17571
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017572 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17573 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017574
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017575Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17576
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017577 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017578 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017579 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17580 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17581 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017582 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17583 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17584 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017585 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017586 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17587 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017588 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017589 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17590 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017591 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017592 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017593 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017594 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017595 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017596 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017597 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017598 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17599 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17600 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17601 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17602 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017603 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017604 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17605 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017606 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017607 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17608 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017609 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17610 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17611 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017612 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017613 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17614 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017615 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017616 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17617 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17618 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017619 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017620 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017621 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17622 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17623 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17624 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017625 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017626 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017627 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017628 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017629 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017630 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017631 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17632 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17633 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017634 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017635 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17636 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017637 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017638 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17639 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017640 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017641 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017642 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017643 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017644
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017645 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017646
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017647
176488.2.5. Error log format
17649-----------------------
17650
17651When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17652protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17653By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17654"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017655will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017656logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17657
17658The format looks like this :
17659
17660 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17661 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17662 Connection error during SSL handshake
17663
17664 Field Format Extract from the example above
17665 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17666 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17667 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17668 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17669 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17670
17671These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17672failures.
17673
17674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176758.3. Advanced logging options
17676-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017677
17678Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17679just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17680options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17681for more information about their usage.
17682
17683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176848.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17685------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017686
17687It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17688haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17689commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17690monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17691ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17692
17693 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17694 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17695 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17696 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17697
17698 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17699 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17700 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017701 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017702 such as other load-balancers.
17703
17704 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17705 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17706 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17707
17708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177098.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17710----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017711
17712The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17713what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17714or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017715"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017716just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17717log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17718after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17719is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17720with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17721with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17722
17723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177248.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17725------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017726
17727Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17728for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17729"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17730retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17731raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17732a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17733file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17734you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17735"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17736
17737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177388.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17739--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017740
17741Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17742multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17743them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17744"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17745logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17746error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17747and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17748too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17749useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17750alternative.
17751
17752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177538.4. Timing events
17754------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017755
17756Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17757reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17758the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17759frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017760mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17761addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17762
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017763Timings events in HTTP mode:
17764
17765 first request 2nd request
17766 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17767 t tr t tr ...
17768 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17769 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17770 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17771 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17772 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17773
17774Timings events in TCP mode:
17775
17776 TCP session
17777 |<----------------->|
17778 t t
17779 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17780 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17781 |<------ Tt ------->|
17782
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017783 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017784 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017785 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17786 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17787 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017788 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017789 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17790 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17791 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17792 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017793
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017794 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17795 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17796 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017797 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17798 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17799 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17800 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17801 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17802 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017803
17804 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17805 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17806 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17807 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17808 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17809 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17810 request typed by hand during a test.
17811
17812 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17813 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017814 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017815 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17816 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17817 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17818 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017819
17820 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17821 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17822 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17823 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17824 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17825
17826 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17827 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17828 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17829 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17830 connection never established.
17831
17832 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17833 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17834 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17835 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17836 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17837 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17838 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17839 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17840 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17841 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17842 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17843
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017844 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17845 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17846 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17847 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17848 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17849 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17850
17851 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17852
17853 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17854 "Ta" can never be negative.
17855
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017856 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17857 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017858 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17859 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017860 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017861
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017862 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017863
17864 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017865 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17866 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017867
17868These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17869protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17870that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017871due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17872"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17873that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017874
17875Most common cases :
17876
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017877 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17878 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17879 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17880 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17881 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17882 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17883 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17884 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17885 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17886 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17887 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017888 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017889
17890 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17891 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17892 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17893 of ms on remote networks.
17894
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017895 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17896 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17897 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017898
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017899 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17900 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17901 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17902 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17903 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17904 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17905 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17906 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17907 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017908
17909Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17910
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017911 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017912 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017913 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017914
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017915 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017916 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17917 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17918
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017919 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017920 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17921 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17922 flags.
17923
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017924 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17925 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017926 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17927 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17928 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17929 the client connection was maintained open.
17930
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017931 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017932 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017933 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017934 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17935
17936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179378.5. Session state at disconnection
17938-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017939
17940TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17941"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
179422-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17943each of which has a special meaning :
17944
17945 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17946 session to terminate :
17947
17948 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17949
17950 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17951 server explicitly refused it.
17952
17953 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17954 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17955 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17956 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017957 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017958
17959 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17960 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017961
17962 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17963 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17964 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17965 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17966 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17967
17968 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17969 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17970 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17971 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17972 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17973
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017974 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17975 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17976
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017977 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17978 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17979 backup connections when going up.
17980
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017981 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17982
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017983 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17984 send or receive data.
17985
17986 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17987 send or receive data.
17988
17989 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17990 with nothing left in the buffers.
17991
17992 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17993
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017994 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017995 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17996
17997 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17998 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17999 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
18000 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
18001 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
18002
18003 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
18004 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
18005
18006 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
18007 server (HTTP only).
18008
18009 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
18010
18011 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
18012 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
18013 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
18014
18015 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
18016 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
18017 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
18018
18019 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
18020
18021 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
18022 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
18023
18024 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
18025 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
18026 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
18027
18028 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
18029 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020018030 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
18031 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018032
18033 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
18034 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
18035 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
18036 another server.
18037
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018038 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018039 server.
18040
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018041 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
18042 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
18043 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
18044 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18045
18046 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
18047 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
18048 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
18049 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
18050
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020018051 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
18052 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
18053 "use-server" rule).
18054
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018055 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18056
18057 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
18058 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
18059
18060 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
18061
18062 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
18063 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
18064 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
18065
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018066 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
18067 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018068 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018069 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
18070 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
18071
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018072 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
18073
18074 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
18075 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
18076
18077 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
18078
18079 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
18080
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018081The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
18082was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018083helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
18084starvation, attacks, etc...
18085
18086The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
18087alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
18088easier finding and understanding.
18089
18090 Flags Reason
18091
18092 -- Normal termination.
18093
18094 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
18095 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
18096 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
18097 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
18098
18099 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
18100 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
18101 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
18102 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
18103 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
18104 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018105
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018106 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18107 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018108 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018109
18110 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
18111 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
18112 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
18113
18114 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
18115 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
18116 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
18117 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
18118 the server takes too long to respond.
18119
18120 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
18121 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
18122 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
18123 long a time to respond.
18124
18125 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
18126 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
18127 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
18128 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018129 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
18130 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018131
18132 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
18133 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
18134 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
18135 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
18136 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020018137 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018138 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
18139 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
18140 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
18141 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
18142 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
18143 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
18144 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
18145 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018146 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020018147 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
18148 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
18149 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018150
18151 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
18152 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018153 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
18154 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
18155 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
18156 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018157
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020018158 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
18159 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
18160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018161 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018162 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
18163 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018164 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018165 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
18166 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
18167
18168 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
18169 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
18170 503 or 504 here.
18171
18172 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
18173 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
18174 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
18175 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
18176 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
18177
18178 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
18179 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018180 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018181 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
18182 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
18183
18184 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
18185 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
18186 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
18187 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
18188 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
18189 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
18190 between haproxy and the server.
18191
18192 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
18193 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
18194 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
18195 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
18196 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
18197 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
18198 solution is to fix the application.
18199
18200 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
18201 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
18202 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
18203 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
18204 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
18205 external attacks.
18206
18207 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
18208 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020018209 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018210 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
18211 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
18212
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018213 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
18214 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
18215 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018216 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020018217 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018218
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018219 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
18220 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
18221 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
18222 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010018223 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
18224 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
18225 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
18226 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
18227 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018228
18229 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
18230 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
18231 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18232 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18233
18234 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18235 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18236 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18237 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18238
18239 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18240 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18241 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18242 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18243
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018244The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18245persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18246important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18247re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18248
18249 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18250
18251 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18252 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18253 set on a GET request.
18254
18255 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18256 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018257 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018258 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18259
18260 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18261 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18262 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18263
18264 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18265 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18266 already got a cookie.
18267
18268 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18269 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18270 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18271 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18272 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18273
18274 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18275 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18276 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18277
18278 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18279 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18280 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18281
18282 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18283 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18284
18285 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18286 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18287 then advertised in the response.
18288
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182908.6. Non-printable characters
18291-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018292
18293In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18294consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18295converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18296prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18297being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18298escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18299is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18300'}' when logging headers.
18301
18302Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18303issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18304containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18305
18306Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18307the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18308performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18309
18310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18312---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018313
18314Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18315achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018316section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018317cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18318the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18319the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018320locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018321not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18322user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18323a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18324wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18325
18326 Examples :
18327 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18328 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18329
18330 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18331 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18332
18333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183348.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18335---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018336
18337Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18338proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18339the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18340server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18341
18342Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18343response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018344section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018345
18346It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018347time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18348appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018349are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18350and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18351follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18352request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18353in the logs.
18354
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018355As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18356frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18357an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18358
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018359 Example :
18360 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18361 listen proxy-out
18362 mode http
18363 option httplog
18364 option logasap
18365 log global
18366 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18367
18368 # log the name of the virtual server
18369 capture request header Host len 20
18370
18371 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18372 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18373
18374 # log the beginning of the referrer
18375 capture request header Referer len 20
18376
18377 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18378 capture response header Server len 20
18379
18380 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18381 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18382
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018383 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018384 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18385
18386 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18387 capture response header Via len 20
18388
18389 # log the URL location during a redirection
18390 capture response header Location len 20
18391
18392 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18393 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18394 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18395 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18396 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18397
18398 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18399 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18400 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18401 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018402 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018403
18404 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18405 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18406 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18407 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18408 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018409 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018410
18411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184128.9. Examples of logs
18413---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018414
18415These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18416them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18417reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18418
18419 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18420 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18421 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18422
18423 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18424 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18425
18426 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18427 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18428 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18429
18430 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18431 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18432
18433 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18434 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18435 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18436
18437 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018438 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018439 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18440 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18441
18442 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18443 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18444 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18445
18446 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18447 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018448 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018449 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18450 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18451 to return the 502 and not the server.
18452
18453 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018454 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018455
18456 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18457 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18458 Nothing was sent to any server.
18459
18460 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18461 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18462
18463 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18464 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018465 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018466 send a 408 return code to the client.
18467
18468 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18469 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18470
18471 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18472 5 seconds ("c----").
18473
18474 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18475 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018476 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018477
18478 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018479 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018480 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18481 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18482 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18483 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18484 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018485
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018486
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200184879. Supported filters
18488--------------------
18489
18490Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18491accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18492unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18493
18494See also : "filter"
18495
184969.1. Trace
18497----------
18498
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018499filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018500
18501 Arguments:
18502 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18503 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18504
18505 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18506 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18507 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18508 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18509
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018510 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018511 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18512 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18513 amount of the parsed data.
18514
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018515 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018516
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018517This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18518callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18519information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18520filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18521
18522Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18523tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18524a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18525
18526
185279.2. HTTP compression
18528---------------------
18529
18530filter compression
18531
18532The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18533keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018534when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18535it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18536response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18537line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18538cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18539the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018540
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018541See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018542
18543
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200185449.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18545--------------------------------------------
18546
18547filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18548
18549 Arguments :
18550
18551 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18552 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18553 parsed.
18554
18555 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18556 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18557 part must be placed in its own scope.
18558
18559The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18560external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018561streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018562exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18563also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18564
18565SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18566the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18567
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018568For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018569"doc/SPOE.txt".
18570
18571Important note:
18572 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18573 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18574
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100185759.4. Cache
18576----------
18577
18578filter cache <name>
18579
18580 Arguments :
18581
18582 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18583
18584The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18585"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018586cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018587other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18588the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18589mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18590filter other than the compression is used for the same
18591listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18592order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018593
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018594See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018595
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001859610. Cache
18597---------
18598
18599HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18600(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18601RAM.
18602
18603The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018604this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018605
18606If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18607independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18608when we try to allocate a new one.
18609
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018610The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018611
18612It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18613"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18614for more details.
18615
18616When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18617replaced by "<CACHE>".
18618
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001861910.1. Limitation
18620----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018621
18622The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18623
18624- If the response is not a 200
18625- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018626- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018627- If the response is not cacheable
18628
18629- If the request is not a GET
18630- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018631- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018632
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018633Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18634filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18635can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18636example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18637"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018638
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001863910.2. Setup
18640-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018641
18642To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18643the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18644
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001864510.2.1. Cache section
18646---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018647
18648cache <name>
18649 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18650 size of cache is mandatory.
18651
18652total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018653 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018654 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018655
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018656max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018657 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18658 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18659 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018660
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018661max-age <seconds>
18662 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18663 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18664 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18665 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18666 default.
18667
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001866810.2.2. Proxy section
18669---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018670
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018671http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018672 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18673 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18674 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18675 after this one.
18676
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018677http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018678 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18679 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18680 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18681 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18682
18683
18684Example:
18685
18686 backend bck1
18687 mode http
18688
18689 http-request cache-use foobar
18690 http-response cache-store foobar
18691 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18692
18693 cache foobar
18694 total-max-size 4
18695 max-age 240
18696
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018697/*
18698 * Local variables:
18699 * fill-column: 79
18700 * End:
18701 */